1 //===---- TargetInfo.cpp - Encapsulate target details -----------*- C++ -*-===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // These classes wrap the information about a call or function 11 // definition used to handle ABI compliancy. 12 // 13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 14 15 #include "TargetInfo.h" 16 #include "ABIInfo.h" 17 #include "CGCXXABI.h" 18 #include "CGValue.h" 19 #include "CodeGenFunction.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h" 21 #include "clang/CodeGen/CGFunctionInfo.h" 22 #include "clang/CodeGen/SwiftCallingConv.h" 23 #include "clang/Frontend/CodeGenOptions.h" 24 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h" 25 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 26 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h" 27 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h" 28 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 29 #include <algorithm> // std::sort 30 31 using namespace clang; 32 using namespace CodeGen; 33 34 // Helper for coercing an aggregate argument or return value into an integer 35 // array of the same size (including padding) and alignment. This alternate 36 // coercion happens only for the RenderScript ABI and can be removed after 37 // runtimes that rely on it are no longer supported. 38 // 39 // RenderScript assumes that the size of the argument / return value in the IR 40 // is the same as the size of the corresponding qualified type. This helper 41 // coerces the aggregate type into an array of the same size (including 42 // padding). This coercion is used in lieu of expansion of struct members or 43 // other canonical coercions that return a coerced-type of larger size. 44 // 45 // Ty - The argument / return value type 46 // Context - The associated ASTContext 47 // LLVMContext - The associated LLVMContext 48 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArray(QualType Ty, 49 ASTContext &Context, 50 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext) { 51 // Alignment and Size are measured in bits. 52 const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 53 const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 54 llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Alignment); 55 const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Alignment - 1) / Alignment; 56 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements)); 57 } 58 59 static void AssignToArrayRange(CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder, 60 llvm::Value *Array, 61 llvm::Value *Value, 62 unsigned FirstIndex, 63 unsigned LastIndex) { 64 // Alternatively, we could emit this as a loop in the source. 65 for (unsigned I = FirstIndex; I <= LastIndex; ++I) { 66 llvm::Value *Cell = 67 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(Builder.getInt8Ty(), Array, I); 68 Builder.CreateAlignedStore(Value, Cell, CharUnits::One()); 69 } 70 } 71 72 static bool isAggregateTypeForABI(QualType T) { 73 return !CodeGenFunction::hasScalarEvaluationKind(T) || 74 T->isMemberFunctionPointerType(); 75 } 76 77 ABIArgInfo 78 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirect(QualType Ty, bool ByRef, bool Realign, 79 llvm::Type *Padding) const { 80 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 81 ByRef, Realign, Padding); 82 } 83 84 ABIArgInfo 85 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(QualType Ty, bool Realign) const { 86 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectInReg(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 87 /*ByRef*/ false, Realign); 88 } 89 90 Address ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 91 QualType Ty) const { 92 return Address::invalid(); 93 } 94 95 ABIInfo::~ABIInfo() {} 96 97 /// Does the given lowering require more than the given number of 98 /// registers when expanded? 99 /// 100 /// This is intended to be the basis of a reasonable basic implementation 101 /// of should{Pass,Return}IndirectlyForSwift. 102 /// 103 /// For most targets, a limit of four total registers is reasonable; this 104 /// limits the amount of code required in order to move around the value 105 /// in case it wasn't produced immediately prior to the call by the caller 106 /// (or wasn't produced in exactly the right registers) or isn't used 107 /// immediately within the callee. But some targets may need to further 108 /// limit the register count due to an inability to support that many 109 /// return registers. 110 static bool occupiesMoreThan(CodeGenTypes &cgt, 111 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalarTypes, 112 unsigned maxAllRegisters) { 113 unsigned intCount = 0, fpCount = 0; 114 for (llvm::Type *type : scalarTypes) { 115 if (type->isPointerTy()) { 116 intCount++; 117 } else if (auto intTy = dyn_cast<llvm::IntegerType>(type)) { 118 auto ptrWidth = cgt.getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 119 intCount += (intTy->getBitWidth() + ptrWidth - 1) / ptrWidth; 120 } else { 121 assert(type->isVectorTy() || type->isFloatingPointTy()); 122 fpCount++; 123 } 124 } 125 126 return (intCount + fpCount > maxAllRegisters); 127 } 128 129 bool SwiftABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize, 130 llvm::Type *eltTy, 131 unsigned numElts) const { 132 // The default implementation of this assumes that the target guarantees 133 // 128-bit SIMD support but nothing more. 134 return (vectorSize.getQuantity() > 8 && vectorSize.getQuantity() <= 16); 135 } 136 137 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(const RecordType *RT, 138 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 139 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 140 if (!RD) 141 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 142 return CXXABI.getRecordArgABI(RD); 143 } 144 145 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(QualType T, 146 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 147 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 148 if (!RT) 149 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 150 return getRecordArgABI(RT, CXXABI); 151 } 152 153 /// Pass transparent unions as if they were the type of the first element. Sema 154 /// should ensure that all elements of the union have the same "machine type". 155 static QualType useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(QualType Ty) { 156 if (const RecordType *UT = Ty->getAsUnionType()) { 157 const RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 158 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) { 159 assert(!UD->field_empty() && "sema created an empty transparent union"); 160 return UD->field_begin()->getType(); 161 } 162 } 163 return Ty; 164 } 165 166 CGCXXABI &ABIInfo::getCXXABI() const { 167 return CGT.getCXXABI(); 168 } 169 170 ASTContext &ABIInfo::getContext() const { 171 return CGT.getContext(); 172 } 173 174 llvm::LLVMContext &ABIInfo::getVMContext() const { 175 return CGT.getLLVMContext(); 176 } 177 178 const llvm::DataLayout &ABIInfo::getDataLayout() const { 179 return CGT.getDataLayout(); 180 } 181 182 const TargetInfo &ABIInfo::getTarget() const { 183 return CGT.getTarget(); 184 } 185 186 bool ABIInfo:: isAndroid() const { return getTarget().getTriple().isAndroid(); } 187 188 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 189 return false; 190 } 191 192 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 193 uint64_t Members) const { 194 return false; 195 } 196 197 bool ABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const { 198 return false; 199 } 200 201 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ABIArgInfo::dump() const { 202 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 203 OS << "(ABIArgInfo Kind="; 204 switch (TheKind) { 205 case Direct: 206 OS << "Direct Type="; 207 if (llvm::Type *Ty = getCoerceToType()) 208 Ty->print(OS); 209 else 210 OS << "null"; 211 break; 212 case Extend: 213 OS << "Extend"; 214 break; 215 case Ignore: 216 OS << "Ignore"; 217 break; 218 case InAlloca: 219 OS << "InAlloca Offset=" << getInAllocaFieldIndex(); 220 break; 221 case Indirect: 222 OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity() 223 << " ByVal=" << getIndirectByVal() 224 << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign(); 225 break; 226 case Expand: 227 OS << "Expand"; 228 break; 229 case CoerceAndExpand: 230 OS << "CoerceAndExpand Type="; 231 getCoerceAndExpandType()->print(OS); 232 break; 233 } 234 OS << ")\n"; 235 } 236 237 // Dynamically round a pointer up to a multiple of the given alignment. 238 static llvm::Value *emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 239 llvm::Value *Ptr, 240 CharUnits Align) { 241 llvm::Value *PtrAsInt = Ptr; 242 // OverflowArgArea = (OverflowArgArea + Align - 1) & -Align; 243 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(PtrAsInt, CGF.IntPtrTy); 244 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(PtrAsInt, 245 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, Align.getQuantity() - 1)); 246 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(PtrAsInt, 247 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, -Align.getQuantity())); 248 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(PtrAsInt, 249 Ptr->getType(), 250 Ptr->getName() + ".aligned"); 251 return PtrAsInt; 252 } 253 254 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 255 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 256 /// 257 /// This version implements the core direct-value passing rules. 258 /// 259 /// \param SlotSize - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 260 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 261 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 262 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 263 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 264 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 265 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. If this 266 /// is false, the returned address might be less-aligned than 267 /// DirectAlign. 268 static Address emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 269 Address VAListAddr, 270 llvm::Type *DirectTy, 271 CharUnits DirectSize, 272 CharUnits DirectAlign, 273 CharUnits SlotSize, 274 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 275 // Cast the element type to i8* if necessary. Some platforms define 276 // va_list as a struct containing an i8* instead of just an i8*. 277 if (VAListAddr.getElementType() != CGF.Int8PtrTy) 278 VAListAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(VAListAddr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 279 280 llvm::Value *Ptr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "argp.cur"); 281 282 // If the CC aligns values higher than the slot size, do so if needed. 283 Address Addr = Address::invalid(); 284 if (AllowHigherAlign && DirectAlign > SlotSize) { 285 Addr = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, DirectAlign), 286 DirectAlign); 287 } else { 288 Addr = Address(Ptr, SlotSize); 289 } 290 291 // Advance the pointer past the argument, then store that back. 292 CharUnits FullDirectSize = DirectSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 293 llvm::Value *NextPtr = 294 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), FullDirectSize, 295 "argp.next"); 296 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr); 297 298 // If the argument is smaller than a slot, and this is a big-endian 299 // target, the argument will be right-adjusted in its slot. 300 if (DirectSize < SlotSize && CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 301 !DirectTy->isStructTy()) { 302 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, SlotSize - DirectSize); 303 } 304 305 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, DirectTy); 306 return Addr; 307 } 308 309 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 310 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 311 /// 312 /// \param IsIndirect - Values of this type are passed indirectly. 313 /// \param ValueInfo - The size and alignment of this type, generally 314 /// computed with getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(ValueTy). 315 /// \param SlotSizeAndAlign - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 316 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 317 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 318 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 319 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 320 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 321 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. 322 static Address emitVoidPtrVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 323 QualType ValueTy, bool IsIndirect, 324 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> ValueInfo, 325 CharUnits SlotSizeAndAlign, 326 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 327 // The size and alignment of the value that was passed directly. 328 CharUnits DirectSize, DirectAlign; 329 if (IsIndirect) { 330 DirectSize = CGF.getPointerSize(); 331 DirectAlign = CGF.getPointerAlign(); 332 } else { 333 DirectSize = ValueInfo.first; 334 DirectAlign = ValueInfo.second; 335 } 336 337 // Cast the address we've calculated to the right type. 338 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(ValueTy); 339 if (IsIndirect) 340 DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 341 342 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, DirectTy, 343 DirectSize, DirectAlign, 344 SlotSizeAndAlign, 345 AllowHigherAlign); 346 347 if (IsIndirect) { 348 Addr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr), ValueInfo.second); 349 } 350 351 return Addr; 352 353 } 354 355 static Address emitMergePHI(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 356 Address Addr1, llvm::BasicBlock *Block1, 357 Address Addr2, llvm::BasicBlock *Block2, 358 const llvm::Twine &Name = "") { 359 assert(Addr1.getType() == Addr2.getType()); 360 llvm::PHINode *PHI = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(Addr1.getType(), 2, Name); 361 PHI->addIncoming(Addr1.getPointer(), Block1); 362 PHI->addIncoming(Addr2.getPointer(), Block2); 363 CharUnits Align = std::min(Addr1.getAlignment(), Addr2.getAlignment()); 364 return Address(PHI, Align); 365 } 366 367 TargetCodeGenInfo::~TargetCodeGenInfo() { delete Info; } 368 369 // If someone can figure out a general rule for this, that would be great. 370 // It's probably just doomed to be platform-dependent, though. 371 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException() const { 372 // Verified for: 373 // x86-64 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 374 // x86-32 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 375 // PowerPC Linux, Darwin 376 // ARM Darwin (*not* EABI) 377 // AArch64 Linux 378 return 32; 379 } 380 381 bool TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 382 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const { 383 // The following conventions are known to require this to be false: 384 // x86_stdcall 385 // MIPS 386 // For everything else, we just prefer false unless we opt out. 387 return false; 388 } 389 390 void 391 TargetCodeGenInfo::getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 392 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const { 393 // This assumes the user is passing a library name like "rt" instead of a 394 // filename like "librt.a/so", and that they don't care whether it's static or 395 // dynamic. 396 Opt = "-l"; 397 Opt += Lib; 398 } 399 400 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 401 return llvm::CallingConv::C; 402 } 403 404 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays); 405 406 /// isEmptyField - Return true iff a the field is "empty", that is it 407 /// is an unnamed bit-field or an (array of) empty record(s). 408 static bool isEmptyField(ASTContext &Context, const FieldDecl *FD, 409 bool AllowArrays) { 410 if (FD->isUnnamedBitfield()) 411 return true; 412 413 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 414 415 // Constant arrays of empty records count as empty, strip them off. 416 // Constant arrays of zero length always count as empty. 417 if (AllowArrays) 418 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 419 if (AT->getSize() == 0) 420 return true; 421 FT = AT->getElementType(); 422 } 423 424 const RecordType *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>(); 425 if (!RT) 426 return false; 427 428 // C++ record fields are never empty, at least in the Itanium ABI. 429 // 430 // FIXME: We should use a predicate for whether this behavior is true in the 431 // current ABI. 432 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) 433 return false; 434 435 return isEmptyRecord(Context, FT, AllowArrays); 436 } 437 438 /// isEmptyRecord - Return true iff a structure contains only empty 439 /// fields. Note that a structure with a flexible array member is not 440 /// considered empty. 441 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays) { 442 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 443 if (!RT) 444 return false; 445 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 446 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 447 return false; 448 449 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 450 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 451 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 452 if (!isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 453 return false; 454 455 for (const auto *I : RD->fields()) 456 if (!isEmptyField(Context, I, AllowArrays)) 457 return false; 458 return true; 459 } 460 461 /// isSingleElementStruct - Determine if a structure is a "single 462 /// element struct", i.e. it has exactly one non-empty field or 463 /// exactly one field which is itself a single element 464 /// struct. Structures with flexible array members are never 465 /// considered single element structs. 466 /// 467 /// \return The field declaration for the single non-empty field, if 468 /// it exists. 469 static const Type *isSingleElementStruct(QualType T, ASTContext &Context) { 470 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 471 if (!RT) 472 return nullptr; 473 474 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 475 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 476 return nullptr; 477 478 const Type *Found = nullptr; 479 480 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 481 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 482 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 483 // Ignore empty records. 484 if (isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 485 continue; 486 487 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element struct. 488 if (Found) 489 return nullptr; 490 491 // If this is non-empty and not a single element struct, the composite 492 // cannot be a single element struct. 493 Found = isSingleElementStruct(I.getType(), Context); 494 if (!Found) 495 return nullptr; 496 } 497 } 498 499 // Check for single element. 500 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 501 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 502 503 // Ignore empty fields. 504 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 505 continue; 506 507 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element 508 // struct. 509 if (Found) 510 return nullptr; 511 512 // Treat single element arrays as the element. 513 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 514 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() != 1) 515 break; 516 FT = AT->getElementType(); 517 } 518 519 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(FT)) { 520 Found = FT.getTypePtr(); 521 } else { 522 Found = isSingleElementStruct(FT, Context); 523 if (!Found) 524 return nullptr; 525 } 526 } 527 528 // We don't consider a struct a single-element struct if it has 529 // padding beyond the element type. 530 if (Found && Context.getTypeSize(Found) != Context.getTypeSize(T)) 531 return nullptr; 532 533 return Found; 534 } 535 536 namespace { 537 Address EmitVAArgInstr(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 538 const ABIArgInfo &AI) { 539 // This default implementation defers to the llvm backend's va_arg 540 // instruction. It can handle only passing arguments directly 541 // (typically only handled in the backend for primitive types), or 542 // aggregates passed indirectly by pointer (NOTE: if the "byval" 543 // flag has ABI impact in the callee, this implementation cannot 544 // work.) 545 546 // Only a few cases are covered here at the moment -- those needed 547 // by the default abi. 548 llvm::Value *Val; 549 550 if (AI.isIndirect()) { 551 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 552 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 553 assert( 554 !AI.getIndirectRealign() && 555 "Unexpected IndirectRealign seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 556 557 auto TyInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 558 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 559 560 llvm::Type *BaseTy = 561 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 562 llvm::Value *Addr = 563 CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), BaseTy); 564 return Address(Addr, TyAlignForABI); 565 } else { 566 assert((AI.isDirect() || AI.isExtend()) && 567 "Unexpected ArgInfo Kind in generic VAArg emitter!"); 568 569 assert(!AI.getInReg() && 570 "Unexpected InReg seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 571 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 572 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 573 assert(!AI.getDirectOffset() && 574 "Unexpected DirectOffset seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 575 assert(!AI.getCoerceToType() && 576 "Unexpected CoerceToType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 577 578 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "varet"); 579 Val = CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), CGF.ConvertType(Ty)); 580 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Val, Temp); 581 return Temp; 582 } 583 } 584 585 /// DefaultABIInfo - The default implementation for ABI specific 586 /// details. This implementation provides information which results in 587 /// self-consistent and sensible LLVM IR generation, but does not 588 /// conform to any particular ABI. 589 class DefaultABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 590 public: 591 DefaultABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 592 593 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 594 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 595 596 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 597 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 598 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 599 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 600 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 601 } 602 603 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 604 QualType Ty) const override { 605 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty)); 606 } 607 }; 608 609 class DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 610 public: 611 DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 612 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 613 }; 614 615 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 616 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 617 618 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 619 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 620 // passed by value. 621 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 622 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 623 624 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 625 } 626 627 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 628 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 629 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 630 631 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 632 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 633 } 634 635 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 636 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 637 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 638 639 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 640 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 641 642 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 643 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 644 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 645 646 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 647 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 648 } 649 650 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 651 // WebAssembly ABI Implementation 652 // 653 // This is a very simple ABI that relies a lot on DefaultABIInfo. 654 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 655 656 class WebAssemblyABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo { 657 public: 658 explicit WebAssemblyABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 659 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 660 661 private: 662 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 663 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 664 665 // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are 666 // non-virtual, but computeInfo and EmitVAArg are virtual, so we 667 // overload them. 668 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 669 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 670 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 671 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 672 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 673 } 674 675 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 676 QualType Ty) const override; 677 }; 678 679 class WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo final : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 680 public: 681 explicit WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 682 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WebAssemblyABIInfo(CGT)) {} 683 }; 684 685 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 686 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 687 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 688 689 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 690 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 691 // passed by value. 692 if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 693 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 694 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 695 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 696 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 697 // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We 698 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(), 699 // though watch out for things like bitfields. 700 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 701 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 702 } 703 704 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 705 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 706 } 707 708 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 709 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 710 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 711 // returned by value. 712 if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) { 713 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 714 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 715 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 716 // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. TODO: We 717 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using 718 // ABIArgInfo::getDirect(). 719 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 720 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 721 } 722 } 723 724 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 725 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy); 726 } 727 728 Address WebAssemblyABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 729 QualType Ty) const { 730 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect=*/ false, 731 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 732 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 733 /*AllowHigherAlign=*/ true); 734 } 735 736 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 737 // le32/PNaCl bitcode ABI Implementation 738 // 739 // This is a simplified version of the x86_32 ABI. Arguments and return values 740 // are always passed on the stack. 741 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 742 743 class PNaClABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 744 public: 745 PNaClABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 746 747 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 748 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 749 750 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 751 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 752 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const override; 753 }; 754 755 class PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 756 public: 757 PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 758 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PNaClABIInfo(CGT)) {} 759 }; 760 761 void PNaClABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 762 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 763 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 764 765 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 766 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 767 } 768 769 Address PNaClABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 770 QualType Ty) const { 771 // The PNaCL ABI is a bit odd, in that varargs don't use normal 772 // function classification. Structs get passed directly for varargs 773 // functions, through a rewriting transform in 774 // pnacl-llvm/lib/Transforms/NaCl/ExpandVarArgs.cpp, which allows 775 // this target to actually support a va_arg instructions with an 776 // aggregate type, unlike other targets. 777 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 778 } 779 780 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 781 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 782 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 783 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 784 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 785 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 786 } else if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 787 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 788 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 789 } else if (Ty->isFloatingType()) { 790 // Floating-point types don't go inreg. 791 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 792 } 793 794 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 795 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 796 } 797 798 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 799 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 800 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 801 802 // In the PNaCl ABI we always return records/structures on the stack. 803 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 804 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 805 806 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 807 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 808 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 809 810 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 811 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 812 } 813 814 /// IsX86_MMXType - Return true if this is an MMX type. 815 bool IsX86_MMXType(llvm::Type *IRType) { 816 // Return true if the type is an MMX type <2 x i32>, <4 x i16>, or <8 x i8>. 817 return IRType->isVectorTy() && IRType->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == 64 && 818 cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() && 819 IRType->getScalarSizeInBits() != 64; 820 } 821 822 static llvm::Type* X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 823 StringRef Constraint, 824 llvm::Type* Ty) { 825 if ((Constraint == "y" || Constraint == "&y") && Ty->isVectorTy()) { 826 if (cast<llvm::VectorType>(Ty)->getBitWidth() != 64) { 827 // Invalid MMX constraint 828 return nullptr; 829 } 830 831 return llvm::Type::getX86_MMXTy(CGF.getLLVMContext()); 832 } 833 834 // No operation needed 835 return Ty; 836 } 837 838 /// Returns true if this type can be passed in SSE registers with the 839 /// X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 840 static bool isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 841 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 842 if (BT->isFloatingPoint() && BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Half) 843 return true; 844 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 845 // vectorcall can pass XMM, YMM, and ZMM vectors. We don't pass SSE1 MMX 846 // registers specially. 847 unsigned VecSize = Context.getTypeSize(VT); 848 if (VecSize == 128 || VecSize == 256 || VecSize == 512) 849 return true; 850 } 851 return false; 852 } 853 854 /// Returns true if this aggregate is small enough to be passed in SSE registers 855 /// in the X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 856 static bool isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(uint64_t NumMembers) { 857 return NumMembers <= 4; 858 } 859 860 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 861 // X86-32 ABI Implementation 862 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 863 864 /// \brief Similar to llvm::CCState, but for Clang. 865 struct CCState { 866 CCState(unsigned CC) : CC(CC), FreeRegs(0), FreeSSERegs(0) {} 867 868 unsigned CC; 869 unsigned FreeRegs; 870 unsigned FreeSSERegs; 871 }; 872 873 /// X86_32ABIInfo - The X86-32 ABI information. 874 class X86_32ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 875 enum Class { 876 Integer, 877 Float 878 }; 879 880 static const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 881 882 bool IsDarwinVectorABI; 883 bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI; 884 bool IsWin32StructABI; 885 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 886 bool IsMCUABI; 887 unsigned DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 888 889 static bool isRegisterSize(unsigned Size) { 890 return (Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32 || Size == 64); 891 } 892 893 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 894 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 895 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 896 } 897 898 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 899 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 900 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 901 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 902 } 903 904 bool shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) const; 905 906 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 907 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 908 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 909 910 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 911 912 /// \brief Return the alignment to use for the given type on the stack. 913 unsigned getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, unsigned Align) const; 914 915 Class classify(QualType Ty) const; 916 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 917 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 918 /// \brief Updates the number of available free registers, returns 919 /// true if any registers were allocated. 920 bool updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 921 922 bool shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, bool &InReg, 923 bool &NeedsPadding) const; 924 bool shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 925 926 bool canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const; 927 928 /// \brief Rewrite the function info so that all memory arguments use 929 /// inalloca. 930 void rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const; 931 932 void addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 933 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 934 QualType Type) const; 935 936 public: 937 938 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 939 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 940 QualType Ty) const override; 941 942 X86_32ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 943 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 944 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 945 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), IsDarwinVectorABI(DarwinVectorABI), 946 IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI), 947 IsWin32StructABI(Win32StructABI), 948 IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI), 949 IsMCUABI(CGT.getTarget().getTriple().isOSIAMCU()), 950 DefaultNumRegisterParameters(NumRegisterParameters) {} 951 952 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 953 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 954 bool asReturnValue) const override { 955 // LLVM's x86-32 lowering currently only assigns up to three 956 // integer registers and three fp registers. Oddly, it'll use up to 957 // four vector registers for vectors, but those can overlap with the 958 // scalar registers. 959 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 3); 960 } 961 }; 962 963 class X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 964 public: 965 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 966 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 967 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 968 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_32ABIInfo( 969 CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, Win32StructABI, 970 NumRegisterParameters, SoftFloatABI)) {} 971 972 static bool isStructReturnInRegABI( 973 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts); 974 975 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 976 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 977 978 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 979 // Darwin uses different dwarf register numbers for EH. 980 if (CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) return 5; 981 return 4; 982 } 983 984 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 985 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 986 987 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 988 StringRef Constraint, 989 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 990 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 991 } 992 993 void addReturnRegisterOutputs(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnValue, 994 std::string &Constraints, 995 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 996 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 997 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, 998 std::string &AsmString, 999 unsigned NumOutputs) const override; 1000 1001 llvm::Constant * 1002 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 1003 unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 1004 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 1005 ('F' << 16) | 1006 ('T' << 24); 1007 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 1008 } 1009 1010 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 1011 return "movl\t%ebp, %ebp" 1012 "\t\t## marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 1013 } 1014 }; 1015 1016 } 1017 1018 /// Rewrite input constraint references after adding some output constraints. 1019 /// In the case where there is one output and one input and we add one output, 1020 /// we need to replace all operand references greater than or equal to 1: 1021 /// mov $0, $1 1022 /// mov eax, $1 1023 /// The result will be: 1024 /// mov $0, $2 1025 /// mov eax, $2 1026 static void rewriteInputConstraintReferences(unsigned FirstIn, 1027 unsigned NumNewOuts, 1028 std::string &AsmString) { 1029 std::string Buf; 1030 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Buf); 1031 size_t Pos = 0; 1032 while (Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1033 size_t DollarStart = AsmString.find('$', Pos); 1034 if (DollarStart == std::string::npos) 1035 DollarStart = AsmString.size(); 1036 size_t DollarEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of('$', DollarStart); 1037 if (DollarEnd == std::string::npos) 1038 DollarEnd = AsmString.size(); 1039 OS << StringRef(&AsmString[Pos], DollarEnd - Pos); 1040 Pos = DollarEnd; 1041 size_t NumDollars = DollarEnd - DollarStart; 1042 if (NumDollars % 2 != 0 && Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1043 // We have an operand reference. 1044 size_t DigitStart = Pos; 1045 size_t DigitEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of("0123456789", DigitStart); 1046 if (DigitEnd == std::string::npos) 1047 DigitEnd = AsmString.size(); 1048 StringRef OperandStr(&AsmString[DigitStart], DigitEnd - DigitStart); 1049 unsigned OperandIndex; 1050 if (!OperandStr.getAsInteger(10, OperandIndex)) { 1051 if (OperandIndex >= FirstIn) 1052 OperandIndex += NumNewOuts; 1053 OS << OperandIndex; 1054 } else { 1055 OS << OperandStr; 1056 } 1057 Pos = DigitEnd; 1058 } 1059 } 1060 AsmString = std::move(OS.str()); 1061 } 1062 1063 /// Add output constraints for EAX:EDX because they are return registers. 1064 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::addReturnRegisterOutputs( 1065 CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnSlot, std::string &Constraints, 1066 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 1067 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 1068 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, std::string &AsmString, 1069 unsigned NumOutputs) const { 1070 uint64_t RetWidth = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(ReturnSlot.getType()); 1071 1072 // Use the EAX constraint if the width is 32 or smaller and EAX:EDX if it is 1073 // larger. 1074 if (!Constraints.empty()) 1075 Constraints += ','; 1076 if (RetWidth <= 32) { 1077 Constraints += "={eax}"; 1078 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int32Ty); 1079 } else { 1080 // Use the 'A' constraint for EAX:EDX. 1081 Constraints += "=A"; 1082 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int64Ty); 1083 } 1084 1085 // Truncate EAX or EAX:EDX to an integer of the appropriate size. 1086 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(CGF.getLLVMContext(), RetWidth); 1087 ResultTruncRegTypes.push_back(CoerceTy); 1088 1089 // Coerce the integer by bitcasting the return slot pointer. 1090 ReturnSlot.setAddress(CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(ReturnSlot.getAddress(), 1091 CoerceTy->getPointerTo())); 1092 ResultRegDests.push_back(ReturnSlot); 1093 1094 rewriteInputConstraintReferences(NumOutputs, 1, AsmString); 1095 } 1096 1097 /// shouldReturnTypeInRegister - Determine if the given type should be 1098 /// returned in a register (for the Darwin and MCU ABI). 1099 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, 1100 ASTContext &Context) const { 1101 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1102 1103 // For i386, type must be register sized. 1104 // For the MCU ABI, it only needs to be <= 8-byte 1105 if ((IsMCUABI && Size > 64) || (!IsMCUABI && !isRegisterSize(Size))) 1106 return false; 1107 1108 if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 1109 // 64- and 128- bit vectors inside structures are not returned in 1110 // registers. 1111 if (Size == 64 || Size == 128) 1112 return false; 1113 1114 return true; 1115 } 1116 1117 // If this is a builtin, pointer, enum, complex type, member pointer, or 1118 // member function pointer it is ok. 1119 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() || 1120 Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isEnumeralType() || 1121 Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) 1122 return true; 1123 1124 // Arrays are treated like records. 1125 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) 1126 return shouldReturnTypeInRegister(AT->getElementType(), Context); 1127 1128 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 1129 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1130 if (!RT) return false; 1131 1132 // FIXME: Traverse bases here too. 1133 1134 // Structure types are passed in register if all fields would be 1135 // passed in a register. 1136 for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) { 1137 // Empty fields are ignored. 1138 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 1139 continue; 1140 1141 // Check fields recursively. 1142 if (!shouldReturnTypeInRegister(FD->getType(), Context)) 1143 return false; 1144 } 1145 return true; 1146 } 1147 1148 static bool is32Or64BitBasicType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) { 1149 // Treat complex types as the element type. 1150 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 1151 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 1152 1153 // Check for a type which we know has a simple scalar argument-passing 1154 // convention without any padding. (We're specifically looking for 32 1155 // and 64-bit integer and integer-equivalents, float, and double.) 1156 if (!Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() && !Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() && 1157 !Ty->isEnumeralType() && !Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 1158 return false; 1159 1160 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1161 return Size == 32 || Size == 64; 1162 } 1163 1164 /// Test whether an argument type which is to be passed indirectly (on the 1165 /// stack) would have the equivalent layout if it was expanded into separate 1166 /// arguments. If so, we prefer to do the latter to avoid inhibiting 1167 /// optimizations. 1168 bool X86_32ABIInfo::canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const { 1169 // We can only expand structure types. 1170 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1171 if (!RT) 1172 return false; 1173 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1174 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 1175 if (!IsWin32StructABI ) { 1176 // On non-Windows, we have to conservatively match our old bitcode 1177 // prototypes in order to be ABI-compatible at the bitcode level. 1178 if (!CXXRD->isCLike()) 1179 return false; 1180 } else { 1181 // Don't do this for dynamic classes. 1182 if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) 1183 return false; 1184 // Don't do this if there are any non-empty bases. 1185 for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base : CXXRD->bases()) { 1186 if (!isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base.getType(), /*AllowArrays=*/true)) 1187 return false; 1188 } 1189 } 1190 } 1191 1192 uint64_t Size = 0; 1193 1194 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 1195 // Scalar arguments on the stack get 4 byte alignment on x86. If the 1196 // argument is smaller than 32-bits, expanding the struct will create 1197 // alignment padding. 1198 if (!is32Or64BitBasicType(FD->getType(), getContext())) 1199 return false; 1200 1201 // FIXME: Reject bit-fields wholesale; there are two problems, we don't know 1202 // how to expand them yet, and the predicate for telling if a bitfield still 1203 // counts as "basic" is more complicated than what we were doing previously. 1204 if (FD->isBitField()) 1205 return false; 1206 1207 Size += getContext().getTypeSize(FD->getType()); 1208 } 1209 1210 // We can do this if there was no alignment padding. 1211 return Size == getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1212 } 1213 1214 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const { 1215 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 1216 // integer register. 1217 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1218 --State.FreeRegs; 1219 if (!IsMCUABI) 1220 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(RetTy); 1221 } 1222 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false); 1223 } 1224 1225 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 1226 CCState &State) const { 1227 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 1228 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1229 1230 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1231 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1232 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall && 1233 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, NumElts)) { 1234 // The LLVM struct type for such an aggregate should lower properly. 1235 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1236 } 1237 1238 if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1239 // On Darwin, some vectors are returned in registers. 1240 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1241 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1242 1243 // 128-bit vectors are a special case; they are returned in 1244 // registers and we need to make sure to pick a type the LLVM 1245 // backend will like. 1246 if (Size == 128) 1247 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::VectorType::get( 1248 llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2)); 1249 1250 // Always return in register if it fits in a general purpose 1251 // register, or if it is 64 bits and has a single element. 1252 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1253 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1254 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1255 Size)); 1256 1257 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1258 } 1259 1260 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1261 } 1262 1263 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 1264 if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 1265 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1266 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1267 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1268 } 1269 1270 // If specified, structs and unions are always indirect. 1271 if (!IsRetSmallStructInRegABI && !RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 1272 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1273 1274 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 1275 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 1276 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1277 1278 // Small structures which are register sized are generally returned 1279 // in a register. 1280 if (shouldReturnTypeInRegister(RetTy, getContext())) { 1281 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1282 1283 // As a special-case, if the struct is a "single-element" struct, and 1284 // the field is of type "float" or "double", return it in a 1285 // floating-point register. (MSVC does not apply this special case.) 1286 // We apply a similar transformation for pointer types to improve the 1287 // quality of the generated IR. 1288 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 1289 if ((!IsWin32StructABI && SeltTy->isRealFloatingType()) 1290 || SeltTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) 1291 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 1292 1293 // FIXME: We should be able to narrow this integer in cases with dead 1294 // padding. 1295 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),Size)); 1296 } 1297 1298 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1299 } 1300 1301 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 1302 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 1303 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1304 1305 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 1306 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 1307 } 1308 1309 static bool isSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1310 return Ty->getAs<VectorType>() && Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == 128; 1311 } 1312 1313 static bool isRecordWithSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1314 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1315 if (!RT) 1316 return 0; 1317 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1318 1319 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 1320 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 1321 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 1322 if (!isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, I.getType())) 1323 return false; 1324 1325 for (const auto *i : RD->fields()) { 1326 QualType FT = i->getType(); 1327 1328 if (isSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1329 return true; 1330 1331 if (isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1332 return true; 1333 } 1334 1335 return false; 1336 } 1337 1338 unsigned X86_32ABIInfo::getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, 1339 unsigned Align) const { 1340 // Otherwise, if the alignment is less than or equal to the minimum ABI 1341 // alignment, just use the default; the backend will handle this. 1342 if (Align <= MinABIStackAlignInBytes) 1343 return 0; // Use default alignment. 1344 1345 // On non-Darwin, the stack type alignment is always 4. 1346 if (!IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1347 // Set explicit alignment, since we may need to realign the top. 1348 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1349 } 1350 1351 // Otherwise, if the type contains an SSE vector type, the alignment is 16. 1352 if (Align >= 16 && (isSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty) || 1353 isRecordWithSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty))) 1354 return 16; 1355 1356 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1357 } 1358 1359 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 1360 CCState &State) const { 1361 if (!ByVal) { 1362 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1363 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 1364 if (!IsMCUABI) 1365 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 1366 } 1367 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 1368 } 1369 1370 // Compute the byval alignment. 1371 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 1372 unsigned StackAlign = getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeAlign); 1373 if (StackAlign == 0) 1374 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true); 1375 1376 // If the stack alignment is less than the type alignment, realign the 1377 // argument. 1378 bool Realign = TypeAlign > StackAlign; 1379 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlign), 1380 /*ByVal=*/true, Realign); 1381 } 1382 1383 X86_32ABIInfo::Class X86_32ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty) const { 1384 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 1385 if (!T) 1386 T = Ty.getTypePtr(); 1387 1388 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1389 BuiltinType::Kind K = BT->getKind(); 1390 if (K == BuiltinType::Float || K == BuiltinType::Double) 1391 return Float; 1392 } 1393 return Integer; 1394 } 1395 1396 bool X86_32ABIInfo::updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1397 if (!IsSoftFloatABI) { 1398 Class C = classify(Ty); 1399 if (C == Float) 1400 return false; 1401 } 1402 1403 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1404 unsigned SizeInRegs = (Size + 31) / 32; 1405 1406 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 1407 return false; 1408 1409 if (!IsMCUABI) { 1410 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 1411 State.FreeRegs = 0; 1412 return false; 1413 } 1414 } else { 1415 // The MCU psABI allows passing parameters in-reg even if there are 1416 // earlier parameters that are passed on the stack. Also, 1417 // it does not allow passing >8-byte structs in-register, 1418 // even if there are 3 free registers available. 1419 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs || SizeInRegs > 2) 1420 return false; 1421 } 1422 1423 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 1424 return true; 1425 } 1426 1427 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, 1428 bool &InReg, 1429 bool &NeedsPadding) const { 1430 // On Windows, aggregates other than HFAs are never passed in registers, and 1431 // they do not consume register slots. Homogenous floating-point aggregates 1432 // (HFAs) have already been dealt with at this point. 1433 if (IsWin32StructABI && isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 1434 return false; 1435 1436 NeedsPadding = false; 1437 InReg = !IsMCUABI; 1438 1439 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1440 return false; 1441 1442 if (IsMCUABI) 1443 return true; 1444 1445 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1446 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1447 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32 && State.FreeRegs) 1448 NeedsPadding = true; 1449 1450 return false; 1451 } 1452 1453 return true; 1454 } 1455 1456 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1457 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1458 return false; 1459 1460 if (IsMCUABI) 1461 return false; 1462 1463 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1464 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1465 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 32) 1466 return false; 1467 1468 return (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || Ty->isPointerType() || 1469 Ty->isReferenceType()); 1470 } 1471 1472 return true; 1473 } 1474 1475 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 1476 CCState &State) const { 1477 // FIXME: Set alignment on indirect arguments. 1478 1479 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 1480 1481 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 1482 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1483 if (RT) { 1484 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 1485 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 1486 return getIndirectResult(Ty, false, State); 1487 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 1488 // The field index doesn't matter, we'll fix it up later. 1489 return ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(/*FieldIndex=*/0); 1490 } 1491 } 1492 1493 // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar 1494 // to other targets. 1495 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1496 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1497 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall && 1498 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 1499 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1500 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1501 if (Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 1502 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1503 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 1504 } 1505 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 1506 } 1507 1508 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 1509 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1510 // FIXME: This should not be byval! 1511 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1512 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1513 1514 // Ignore empty structs/unions on non-Windows. 1515 if (!IsWin32StructABI && isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 1516 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1517 1518 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 1519 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 1520 bool NeedsPadding = false; 1521 bool InReg; 1522 if (shouldAggregateUseDirect(Ty, State, InReg, NeedsPadding)) { 1523 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 1524 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 1525 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 1526 if (InReg) 1527 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 1528 else 1529 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result); 1530 } 1531 llvm::IntegerType *PaddingType = NeedsPadding ? Int32 : nullptr; 1532 1533 // Expand small (<= 128-bit) record types when we know that the stack layout 1534 // of those arguments will match the struct. This is important because the 1535 // LLVM backend isn't smart enough to remove byval, which inhibits many 1536 // optimizations. 1537 // Don't do this for the MCU if there are still free integer registers 1538 // (see X86_64 ABI for full explanation). 1539 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 4 * 32 && 1540 (!IsMCUABI || State.FreeRegs == 0) && canExpandIndirectArgument(Ty)) 1541 return ABIArgInfo::getExpandWithPadding( 1542 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1543 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall, 1544 PaddingType); 1545 1546 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1547 } 1548 1549 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1550 // On Darwin, some vectors are passed in memory, we handle this by passing 1551 // it as an i8/i16/i32/i64. 1552 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1553 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1554 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1555 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1556 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1557 Size)); 1558 } 1559 1560 if (IsX86_MMXType(CGT.ConvertType(Ty))) 1561 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64)); 1562 1563 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1564 } 1565 1566 1567 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 1568 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1569 1570 bool InReg = shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(Ty, State); 1571 1572 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 1573 if (InReg) 1574 return ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(); 1575 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 1576 } 1577 1578 if (InReg) 1579 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 1580 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1581 } 1582 1583 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1584 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 1585 if (IsMCUABI) 1586 State.FreeRegs = 3; 1587 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall) 1588 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1589 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1590 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1591 State.FreeSSERegs = 6; 1592 } else if (FI.getHasRegParm()) 1593 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 1594 else 1595 State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 1596 1597 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) { 1598 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), State); 1599 } else if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) { 1600 // The C++ ABI is not aware of register usage, so we have to check if the 1601 // return value was sret and put it in a register ourselves if appropriate. 1602 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1603 --State.FreeRegs; // The sret parameter consumes a register. 1604 if (!IsMCUABI) 1605 FI.getReturnInfo().setInReg(true); 1606 } 1607 } 1608 1609 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 1610 if (FI.isChainCall()) 1611 ++State.FreeRegs; 1612 1613 bool UsedInAlloca = false; 1614 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1615 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 1616 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1617 } 1618 1619 // If we needed to use inalloca for any argument, do a second pass and rewrite 1620 // all the memory arguments to use inalloca. 1621 if (UsedInAlloca) 1622 rewriteWithInAlloca(FI); 1623 } 1624 1625 void 1626 X86_32ABIInfo::addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 1627 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 1628 QualType Type) const { 1629 // Arguments are always 4-byte-aligned. 1630 CharUnits FieldAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1631 1632 assert(StackOffset.isMultipleOf(FieldAlign) && "unaligned inalloca struct"); 1633 Info = ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(FrameFields.size()); 1634 FrameFields.push_back(CGT.ConvertTypeForMem(Type)); 1635 StackOffset += getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Type); 1636 1637 // Insert padding bytes to respect alignment. 1638 CharUnits FieldEnd = StackOffset; 1639 StackOffset = FieldEnd.alignTo(FieldAlign); 1640 if (StackOffset != FieldEnd) { 1641 CharUnits NumBytes = StackOffset - FieldEnd; 1642 llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()); 1643 Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(Ty, NumBytes.getQuantity()); 1644 FrameFields.push_back(Ty); 1645 } 1646 } 1647 1648 static bool isArgInAlloca(const ABIArgInfo &Info) { 1649 // Leave ignored and inreg arguments alone. 1650 switch (Info.getKind()) { 1651 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 1652 return true; 1653 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 1654 assert(Info.getIndirectByVal()); 1655 return true; 1656 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 1657 return false; 1658 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 1659 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 1660 if (Info.getInReg()) 1661 return false; 1662 return true; 1663 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 1664 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 1665 // These are aggregate types which are never passed in registers when 1666 // inalloca is involved. 1667 return true; 1668 } 1669 llvm_unreachable("invalid enum"); 1670 } 1671 1672 void X86_32ABIInfo::rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1673 assert(IsWin32StructABI && "inalloca only supported on win32"); 1674 1675 // Build a packed struct type for all of the arguments in memory. 1676 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> FrameFields; 1677 1678 // The stack alignment is always 4. 1679 CharUnits StackAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1680 1681 CharUnits StackOffset; 1682 CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator I = FI.arg_begin(), E = FI.arg_end(); 1683 1684 // Put 'this' into the struct before 'sret', if necessary. 1685 bool IsThisCall = 1686 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_ThisCall; 1687 ABIArgInfo &Ret = FI.getReturnInfo(); 1688 if (Ret.isIndirect() && Ret.isSRetAfterThis() && !IsThisCall && 1689 isArgInAlloca(I->info)) { 1690 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1691 ++I; 1692 } 1693 1694 // Put the sret parameter into the inalloca struct if it's in memory. 1695 if (Ret.isIndirect() && !Ret.getInReg()) { 1696 CanQualType PtrTy = getContext().getPointerType(FI.getReturnType()); 1697 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, Ret, PtrTy); 1698 // On Windows, the hidden sret parameter is always returned in eax. 1699 Ret.setInAllocaSRet(IsWin32StructABI); 1700 } 1701 1702 // Skip the 'this' parameter in ecx. 1703 if (IsThisCall) 1704 ++I; 1705 1706 // Put arguments passed in memory into the struct. 1707 for (; I != E; ++I) { 1708 if (isArgInAlloca(I->info)) 1709 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1710 } 1711 1712 FI.setArgStruct(llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), FrameFields, 1713 /*isPacked=*/true), 1714 StackAlign); 1715 } 1716 1717 Address X86_32ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1718 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const { 1719 1720 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 1721 1722 // x86-32 changes the alignment of certain arguments on the stack. 1723 // 1724 // Just messing with TypeInfo like this works because we never pass 1725 // anything indirectly. 1726 TypeInfo.second = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 1727 getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeInfo.second.getQuantity())); 1728 1729 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 1730 TypeInfo, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 1731 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 1732 } 1733 1734 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI( 1735 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) { 1736 assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86); 1737 1738 switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) { 1739 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default: 1740 break; 1741 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack: // -fpcc-struct-return 1742 return false; 1743 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs: // -freg-struct-return 1744 return true; 1745 } 1746 1747 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.isOSIAMCU()) 1748 return true; 1749 1750 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 1751 case llvm::Triple::DragonFly: 1752 case llvm::Triple::FreeBSD: 1753 case llvm::Triple::OpenBSD: 1754 case llvm::Triple::Bitrig: 1755 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 1756 return true; 1757 default: 1758 return false; 1759 } 1760 } 1761 1762 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 1763 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 1764 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 1765 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1766 if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) { 1767 // Get the LLVM function. 1768 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1769 1770 // Now add the 'alignstack' attribute with a value of 16. 1771 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 1772 B.addStackAlignmentAttr(16); 1773 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeSet::FunctionIndex, 1774 llvm::AttributeSet::get(CGM.getLLVMContext(), 1775 llvm::AttributeSet::FunctionIndex, 1776 B)); 1777 } 1778 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 1779 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1780 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 1781 } 1782 } 1783 } 1784 1785 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 1786 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1787 llvm::Value *Address) const { 1788 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 1789 1790 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 1791 1792 // 0-7 are the eight integer registers; the order is different 1793 // on Darwin (for EH), but the range is the same. 1794 // 8 is %eip. 1795 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 8); 1796 1797 if (CGF.CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) { 1798 // 12-16 are st(0..4). Not sure why we stop at 4. 1799 // These have size 16, which is sizeof(long double) on 1800 // platforms with 8-byte alignment for that type. 1801 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 16); 1802 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 12, 16); 1803 1804 } else { 1805 // 9 is %eflags, which doesn't get a size on Darwin for some 1806 // reason. 1807 Builder.CreateAlignedStore( 1808 Four8, Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(CGF.Int8Ty, Address, 9), 1809 CharUnits::One()); 1810 1811 // 11-16 are st(0..5). Not sure why we stop at 5. 1812 // These have size 12, which is sizeof(long double) on 1813 // platforms with 4-byte alignment for that type. 1814 llvm::Value *Twelve8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 12); 1815 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Twelve8, 11, 16); 1816 } 1817 1818 return false; 1819 } 1820 1821 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1822 // X86-64 ABI Implementation 1823 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1824 1825 1826 namespace { 1827 /// The AVX ABI level for X86 targets. 1828 enum class X86AVXABILevel { 1829 None, 1830 AVX, 1831 AVX512 1832 }; 1833 1834 /// \p returns the size in bits of the largest (native) vector for \p AVXLevel. 1835 static unsigned getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) { 1836 switch (AVXLevel) { 1837 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX512: 1838 return 512; 1839 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX: 1840 return 256; 1841 case X86AVXABILevel::None: 1842 return 128; 1843 } 1844 llvm_unreachable("Unknown AVXLevel"); 1845 } 1846 1847 /// X86_64ABIInfo - The X86_64 ABI information. 1848 class X86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 1849 enum Class { 1850 Integer = 0, 1851 SSE, 1852 SSEUp, 1853 X87, 1854 X87Up, 1855 ComplexX87, 1856 NoClass, 1857 Memory 1858 }; 1859 1860 /// merge - Implement the X86_64 ABI merging algorithm. 1861 /// 1862 /// Merge an accumulating classification \arg Accum with a field 1863 /// classification \arg Field. 1864 /// 1865 /// \param Accum - The accumulating classification. This should 1866 /// always be either NoClass or the result of a previous merge 1867 /// call. In addition, this should never be Memory (the caller 1868 /// should just return Memory for the aggregate). 1869 static Class merge(Class Accum, Class Field); 1870 1871 /// postMerge - Implement the X86_64 ABI post merging algorithm. 1872 /// 1873 /// Post merger cleanup, reduces a malformed Hi and Lo pair to 1874 /// final MEMORY or SSE classes when necessary. 1875 /// 1876 /// \param AggregateSize - The size of the current aggregate in 1877 /// the classification process. 1878 /// 1879 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 1880 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 1881 /// 1882 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 1883 /// residing in the higher words of the containing object. 1884 /// 1885 void postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, Class &Hi) const; 1886 1887 /// classify - Determine the x86_64 register classes in which the 1888 /// given type T should be passed. 1889 /// 1890 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 1891 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 1892 /// 1893 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 1894 /// residing in the high word of the containing object. 1895 /// 1896 /// \param OffsetBase - The bit offset of this type in the 1897 /// containing object. Some parameters are classified different 1898 /// depending on whether they straddle an eightbyte boundary. 1899 /// 1900 /// \param isNamedArg - Whether the argument in question is a "named" 1901 /// argument, as used in AMD64-ABI 3.5.7. 1902 /// 1903 /// If a word is unused its result will be NoClass; if a type should 1904 /// be passed in Memory then at least the classification of \arg Lo 1905 /// will be Memory. 1906 /// 1907 /// The \arg Lo class will be NoClass iff the argument is ignored. 1908 /// 1909 /// If the \arg Lo class is ComplexX87, then the \arg Hi class will 1910 /// also be ComplexX87. 1911 void classify(QualType T, uint64_t OffsetBase, Class &Lo, Class &Hi, 1912 bool isNamedArg) const; 1913 1914 llvm::Type *GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 1915 llvm::Type *GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 1916 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 1917 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 1918 llvm::Type *GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 1919 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 1920 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 1921 1922 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 1923 /// such that the argument will be returned in memory. 1924 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const; 1925 1926 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 1927 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 1928 /// 1929 /// \param freeIntRegs - The number of free integer registers remaining 1930 /// available. 1931 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs) const; 1932 1933 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 1934 1935 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 1936 unsigned freeIntRegs, 1937 unsigned &neededInt, 1938 unsigned &neededSSE, 1939 bool isNamedArg) const; 1940 1941 bool IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 1942 1943 /// The 0.98 ABI revision clarified a lot of ambiguities, 1944 /// unfortunately in ways that were not always consistent with 1945 /// certain previous compilers. In particular, platforms which 1946 /// required strict binary compatibility with older versions of GCC 1947 /// may need to exempt themselves. 1948 bool honorsRevision0_98() const { 1949 return !getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin(); 1950 } 1951 1952 /// GCC classifies <1 x long long> as SSE but compatibility with older clang 1953 // compilers require us to classify it as INTEGER. 1954 bool classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() const { 1955 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 1956 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::PS4) 1957 return false; 1958 if (Triple.isOSFreeBSD() && Triple.getOSMajorVersion() >= 10) 1959 return false; 1960 return true; 1961 } 1962 1963 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel; 1964 // Some ABIs (e.g. X32 ABI and Native Client OS) use 32 bit pointers on 1965 // 64-bit hardware. 1966 bool Has64BitPointers; 1967 1968 public: 1969 X86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) : 1970 SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel), 1971 Has64BitPointers(CGT.getDataLayout().getPointerSize(0) == 8) { 1972 } 1973 1974 bool isPassedUsingAVXType(QualType type) const { 1975 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 1976 // The freeIntRegs argument doesn't matter here. 1977 ABIArgInfo info = classifyArgumentType(type, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 1978 /*isNamedArg*/true); 1979 if (info.isDirect()) { 1980 llvm::Type *ty = info.getCoerceToType(); 1981 if (llvm::VectorType *vectorTy = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::VectorType>(ty)) 1982 return (vectorTy->getBitWidth() > 128); 1983 } 1984 return false; 1985 } 1986 1987 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 1988 1989 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 1990 QualType Ty) const override; 1991 Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 1992 QualType Ty) const override; 1993 1994 bool has64BitPointers() const { 1995 return Has64BitPointers; 1996 } 1997 1998 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 1999 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 2000 bool asReturnValue) const override { 2001 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 2002 } 2003 }; 2004 2005 /// WinX86_64ABIInfo - The Windows X86_64 ABI information. 2006 class WinX86_64ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 2007 public: 2008 WinX86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 2009 : ABIInfo(CGT), 2010 IsMingw64(getTarget().getTriple().isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) {} 2011 2012 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 2013 2014 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2015 QualType Ty) const override; 2016 2017 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 2018 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2019 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 2020 } 2021 2022 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 2023 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 2024 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2025 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 2026 } 2027 2028 private: 2029 ABIArgInfo classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 2030 bool IsReturnType) const; 2031 2032 bool IsMingw64; 2033 }; 2034 2035 class X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2036 public: 2037 X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2038 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_64ABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel)) {} 2039 2040 const X86_64ABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 2041 return static_cast<const X86_64ABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 2042 } 2043 2044 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2045 return 7; 2046 } 2047 2048 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2049 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2050 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2051 2052 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2053 // 16 is %rip. 2054 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2055 return false; 2056 } 2057 2058 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2059 StringRef Constraint, 2060 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 2061 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 2062 } 2063 2064 bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 2065 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override { 2066 // The default CC on x86-64 sets %al to the number of SSA 2067 // registers used, and GCC sets this when calling an unprototyped 2068 // function, so we override the default behavior. However, don't do 2069 // that when AVX types are involved: the ABI explicitly states it is 2070 // undefined, and it doesn't work in practice because of how the ABI 2071 // defines varargs anyway. 2072 if (fnType->getCallConv() == CC_C) { 2073 bool HasAVXType = false; 2074 for (CallArgList::const_iterator 2075 it = args.begin(), ie = args.end(); it != ie; ++it) { 2076 if (getABIInfo().isPassedUsingAVXType(it->Ty)) { 2077 HasAVXType = true; 2078 break; 2079 } 2080 } 2081 2082 if (!HasAVXType) 2083 return true; 2084 } 2085 2086 return TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(args, fnType); 2087 } 2088 2089 llvm::Constant * 2090 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2091 unsigned Sig; 2092 if (getABIInfo().has64BitPointers()) 2093 Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 2094 (0x0a << 8) | // .+0x0c 2095 ('F' << 16) | 2096 ('T' << 24); 2097 else 2098 Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 2099 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 2100 ('F' << 16) | 2101 ('T' << 24); 2102 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 2103 } 2104 2105 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2106 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2107 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2108 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2109 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2110 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2111 } 2112 } 2113 } 2114 }; 2115 2116 class PS4TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo { 2117 public: 2118 PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2119 : X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, AVXLevel) {} 2120 2121 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2122 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2123 Opt = "\01"; 2124 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2125 if (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos) 2126 Opt += "\"" + Lib.str() + "\""; 2127 else 2128 Opt += Lib; 2129 } 2130 }; 2131 2132 static std::string qualifyWindowsLibrary(llvm::StringRef Lib) { 2133 // If the argument does not end in .lib, automatically add the suffix. 2134 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2135 // This matches the behavior of MSVC. 2136 bool Quote = (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos); 2137 std::string ArgStr = Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2138 ArgStr += Lib; 2139 if (!Lib.endswith_lower(".lib")) 2140 ArgStr += ".lib"; 2141 ArgStr += Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2142 return ArgStr; 2143 } 2144 2145 class WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo { 2146 public: 2147 WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2148 bool DarwinVectorABI, bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 2149 unsigned NumRegisterParameters) 2150 : X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 2151 Win32StructABI, NumRegisterParameters, false) {} 2152 2153 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2154 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2155 2156 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2157 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2158 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2159 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2160 } 2161 2162 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2163 llvm::StringRef Value, 2164 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2165 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2166 } 2167 }; 2168 2169 static void addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(const Decl *D, 2170 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2171 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) { 2172 if (D && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2173 if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize != 4096) { 2174 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2175 2176 Fn->addFnAttr("stack-probe-size", 2177 llvm::utostr(CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize)); 2178 } 2179 } 2180 } 2181 2182 void WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 2183 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2184 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2185 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2186 2187 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 2188 } 2189 2190 class WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2191 public: 2192 WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2193 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2194 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WinX86_64ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 2195 2196 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2197 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2198 2199 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2200 return 7; 2201 } 2202 2203 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2204 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2205 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2206 2207 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2208 // 16 is %rip. 2209 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2210 return false; 2211 } 2212 2213 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2214 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2215 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2216 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2217 } 2218 2219 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2220 llvm::StringRef Value, 2221 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2222 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2223 } 2224 }; 2225 2226 void WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 2227 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2228 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2229 TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2230 2231 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2232 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2233 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2234 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2235 } 2236 } 2237 2238 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 2239 } 2240 } 2241 2242 void X86_64ABIInfo::postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, 2243 Class &Hi) const { 2244 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 5. Then a post merger cleanup is done: 2245 // 2246 // (a) If one of the classes is Memory, the whole argument is passed in 2247 // memory. 2248 // 2249 // (b) If X87UP is not preceded by X87, the whole argument is passed in 2250 // memory. 2251 // 2252 // (c) If the size of the aggregate exceeds two eightbytes and the first 2253 // eightbyte isn't SSE or any other eightbyte isn't SSEUP, the whole 2254 // argument is passed in memory. NOTE: This is necessary to keep the 2255 // ABI working for processors that don't support the __m256 type. 2256 // 2257 // (d) If SSEUP is not preceded by SSE or SSEUP, it is converted to SSE. 2258 // 2259 // Some of these are enforced by the merging logic. Others can arise 2260 // only with unions; for example: 2261 // union { _Complex double; unsigned; } 2262 // 2263 // Note that clauses (b) and (c) were added in 0.98. 2264 // 2265 if (Hi == Memory) 2266 Lo = Memory; 2267 if (Hi == X87Up && Lo != X87 && honorsRevision0_98()) 2268 Lo = Memory; 2269 if (AggregateSize > 128 && (Lo != SSE || Hi != SSEUp)) 2270 Lo = Memory; 2271 if (Hi == SSEUp && Lo != SSE) 2272 Hi = SSE; 2273 } 2274 2275 X86_64ABIInfo::Class X86_64ABIInfo::merge(Class Accum, Class Field) { 2276 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 4. Each field of an object is 2277 // classified recursively so that always two fields are 2278 // considered. The resulting class is calculated according to 2279 // the classes of the fields in the eightbyte: 2280 // 2281 // (a) If both classes are equal, this is the resulting class. 2282 // 2283 // (b) If one of the classes is NO_CLASS, the resulting class is 2284 // the other class. 2285 // 2286 // (c) If one of the classes is MEMORY, the result is the MEMORY 2287 // class. 2288 // 2289 // (d) If one of the classes is INTEGER, the result is the 2290 // INTEGER. 2291 // 2292 // (e) If one of the classes is X87, X87UP, COMPLEX_X87 class, 2293 // MEMORY is used as class. 2294 // 2295 // (f) Otherwise class SSE is used. 2296 2297 // Accum should never be memory (we should have returned) or 2298 // ComplexX87 (because this cannot be passed in a structure). 2299 assert((Accum != Memory && Accum != ComplexX87) && 2300 "Invalid accumulated classification during merge."); 2301 if (Accum == Field || Field == NoClass) 2302 return Accum; 2303 if (Field == Memory) 2304 return Memory; 2305 if (Accum == NoClass) 2306 return Field; 2307 if (Accum == Integer || Field == Integer) 2308 return Integer; 2309 if (Field == X87 || Field == X87Up || Field == ComplexX87 || 2310 Accum == X87 || Accum == X87Up) 2311 return Memory; 2312 return SSE; 2313 } 2314 2315 void X86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, uint64_t OffsetBase, 2316 Class &Lo, Class &Hi, bool isNamedArg) const { 2317 // FIXME: This code can be simplified by introducing a simple value class for 2318 // Class pairs with appropriate constructor methods for the various 2319 // situations. 2320 2321 // FIXME: Some of the split computations are wrong; unaligned vectors 2322 // shouldn't be passed in registers for example, so there is no chance they 2323 // can straddle an eightbyte. Verify & simplify. 2324 2325 Lo = Hi = NoClass; 2326 2327 Class &Current = OffsetBase < 64 ? Lo : Hi; 2328 Current = Memory; 2329 2330 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2331 BuiltinType::Kind k = BT->getKind(); 2332 2333 if (k == BuiltinType::Void) { 2334 Current = NoClass; 2335 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Int128 || k == BuiltinType::UInt128) { 2336 Lo = Integer; 2337 Hi = Integer; 2338 } else if (k >= BuiltinType::Bool && k <= BuiltinType::LongLong) { 2339 Current = Integer; 2340 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Float || k == BuiltinType::Double) { 2341 Current = SSE; 2342 } else if (k == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 2343 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2344 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad) { 2345 Lo = SSE; 2346 Hi = SSEUp; 2347 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended) { 2348 Lo = X87; 2349 Hi = X87Up; 2350 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble) { 2351 Current = SSE; 2352 } else 2353 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2354 } 2355 // FIXME: _Decimal32 and _Decimal64 are SSE. 2356 // FIXME: _float128 and _Decimal128 are (SSE, SSEUp). 2357 return; 2358 } 2359 2360 if (const EnumType *ET = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2361 // Classify the underlying integer type. 2362 classify(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(), OffsetBase, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 2363 return; 2364 } 2365 2366 if (Ty->hasPointerRepresentation()) { 2367 Current = Integer; 2368 return; 2369 } 2370 2371 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 2372 if (Ty->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) { 2373 if (Has64BitPointers) { 2374 // If Has64BitPointers, this is an {i64, i64}, so classify both 2375 // Lo and Hi now. 2376 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2377 } else { 2378 // Otherwise, with 32-bit pointers, this is an {i32, i32}. If that 2379 // straddles an eightbyte boundary, Hi should be classified as well. 2380 uint64_t EB_FuncPtr = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2381 uint64_t EB_ThisAdj = (OffsetBase + 64 - 1) / 64; 2382 if (EB_FuncPtr != EB_ThisAdj) { 2383 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2384 } else { 2385 Current = Integer; 2386 } 2387 } 2388 } else { 2389 Current = Integer; 2390 } 2391 return; 2392 } 2393 2394 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2395 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 2396 if (Size == 1 || Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) { 2397 // gcc passes the following as integer: 2398 // 4 bytes - <4 x char>, <2 x short>, <1 x int>, <1 x float> 2399 // 2 bytes - <2 x char>, <1 x short> 2400 // 1 byte - <1 x char> 2401 Current = Integer; 2402 2403 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2404 // split. 2405 uint64_t EB_Lo = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2406 uint64_t EB_Hi = (OffsetBase + Size - 1) / 64; 2407 if (EB_Lo != EB_Hi) 2408 Hi = Lo; 2409 } else if (Size == 64) { 2410 QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType(); 2411 2412 // gcc passes <1 x double> in memory. :( 2413 if (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) 2414 return; 2415 2416 // gcc passes <1 x long long> as SSE but clang used to unconditionally 2417 // pass them as integer. For platforms where clang is the de facto 2418 // platform compiler, we must continue to use integer. 2419 if (!classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() && 2420 (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) || 2421 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) || 2422 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Long) || 2423 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULong))) 2424 Current = Integer; 2425 else 2426 Current = SSE; 2427 2428 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2429 // split. 2430 if (OffsetBase && OffsetBase != 64) 2431 Hi = Lo; 2432 } else if (Size == 128 || 2433 (isNamedArg && Size <= getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2434 // Arguments of 256-bits are split into four eightbyte chunks. The 2435 // least significant one belongs to class SSE and all the others to class 2436 // SSEUP. The original Lo and Hi design considers that types can't be 2437 // greater than 128-bits, so a 64-bit split in Hi and Lo makes sense. 2438 // This design isn't correct for 256-bits, but since there're no cases 2439 // where the upper parts would need to be inspected, avoid adding 2440 // complexity and just consider Hi to match the 64-256 part. 2441 // 2442 // Note that per 3.5.7 of AMD64-ABI, 256-bit args are only passed in 2443 // registers if they are "named", i.e. not part of the "..." of a 2444 // variadic function. 2445 // 2446 // Similarly, per 3.2.3. of the AVX512 draft, 512-bits ("named") args are 2447 // split into eight eightbyte chunks, one SSE and seven SSEUP. 2448 Lo = SSE; 2449 Hi = SSEUp; 2450 } 2451 return; 2452 } 2453 2454 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 2455 QualType ET = getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType()); 2456 2457 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2458 if (ET->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 2459 if (Size <= 64) 2460 Current = Integer; 2461 else if (Size <= 128) 2462 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2463 } else if (ET == getContext().FloatTy) { 2464 Current = SSE; 2465 } else if (ET == getContext().DoubleTy) { 2466 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2467 } else if (ET == getContext().LongDoubleTy) { 2468 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2469 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad) 2470 Current = Memory; 2471 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended) 2472 Current = ComplexX87; 2473 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble) 2474 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2475 else 2476 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2477 } 2478 2479 // If this complex type crosses an eightbyte boundary then it 2480 // should be split. 2481 uint64_t EB_Real = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2482 uint64_t EB_Imag = (OffsetBase + getContext().getTypeSize(ET)) / 64; 2483 if (Hi == NoClass && EB_Real != EB_Imag) 2484 Hi = Lo; 2485 2486 return; 2487 } 2488 2489 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 2490 // Arrays are treated like structures. 2491 2492 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2493 2494 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2495 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2496 if (Size > 512) 2497 return; 2498 2499 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If ..., or it contains unaligned 2500 // fields, it has class MEMORY. 2501 // 2502 // Only need to check alignment of array base. 2503 if (OffsetBase % getContext().getTypeAlign(AT->getElementType())) 2504 return; 2505 2506 // Otherwise implement simplified merge. We could be smarter about 2507 // this, but it isn't worth it and would be harder to verify. 2508 Current = NoClass; 2509 uint64_t EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 2510 uint64_t ArraySize = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 2511 2512 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the array 2513 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2514 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2515 // 2516 if (Size > 128 && 2517 (Size != EltSize || Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) 2518 return; 2519 2520 for (uint64_t i=0, Offset=OffsetBase; i<ArraySize; ++i, Offset += EltSize) { 2521 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2522 classify(AT->getElementType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2523 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2524 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2525 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2526 break; 2527 } 2528 2529 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2530 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp array classification."); 2531 return; 2532 } 2533 2534 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2535 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2536 2537 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2538 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2539 if (Size > 512) 2540 return; 2541 2542 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 2. If a C++ object has either a non-trivial 2543 // copy constructor or a non-trivial destructor, it is passed by invisible 2544 // reference. 2545 if (getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 2546 return; 2547 2548 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2549 2550 // Assume variable sized types are passed in memory. 2551 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 2552 return; 2553 2554 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2555 2556 // Reset Lo class, this will be recomputed. 2557 Current = NoClass; 2558 2559 // If this is a C++ record, classify the bases first. 2560 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2561 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 2562 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 2563 "Unexpected base class!"); 2564 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 2565 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2566 2567 // Classify this field. 2568 // 2569 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate exceeds a 2570 // single eightbyte, each is classified separately. Each eightbyte gets 2571 // initialized to class NO_CLASS. 2572 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2573 uint64_t Offset = 2574 OffsetBase + getContext().toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 2575 classify(I.getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2576 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2577 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2578 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) { 2579 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2580 return; 2581 } 2582 } 2583 } 2584 2585 // Classify the fields one at a time, merging the results. 2586 unsigned idx = 0; 2587 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 2588 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 2589 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2590 bool BitField = i->isBitField(); 2591 2592 // Ignore padding bit-fields. 2593 if (BitField && i->isUnnamedBitfield()) 2594 continue; 2595 2596 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger than 2597 // four eightbytes, or it contains unaligned fields, it has class MEMORY. 2598 // 2599 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the struct 2600 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2601 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2602 // 2603 if (Size > 128 && (Size != getContext().getTypeSize(i->getType()) || 2604 Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2605 Lo = Memory; 2606 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2607 return; 2608 } 2609 // Note, skip this test for bit-fields, see below. 2610 if (!BitField && Offset % getContext().getTypeAlign(i->getType())) { 2611 Lo = Memory; 2612 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2613 return; 2614 } 2615 2616 // Classify this field. 2617 // 2618 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate 2619 // exceeds a single eightbyte, each is classified 2620 // separately. Each eightbyte gets initialized to class 2621 // NO_CLASS. 2622 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2623 2624 // Bit-fields require special handling, they do not force the 2625 // structure to be passed in memory even if unaligned, and 2626 // therefore they can straddle an eightbyte. 2627 if (BitField) { 2628 assert(!i->isUnnamedBitfield()); 2629 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2630 uint64_t Size = i->getBitWidthValue(getContext()); 2631 2632 uint64_t EB_Lo = Offset / 64; 2633 uint64_t EB_Hi = (Offset + Size - 1) / 64; 2634 2635 if (EB_Lo) { 2636 assert(EB_Hi == EB_Lo && "Invalid classification, type > 16 bytes."); 2637 FieldLo = NoClass; 2638 FieldHi = Integer; 2639 } else { 2640 FieldLo = Integer; 2641 FieldHi = EB_Hi ? Integer : NoClass; 2642 } 2643 } else 2644 classify(i->getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2645 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2646 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2647 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2648 break; 2649 } 2650 2651 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2652 } 2653 } 2654 2655 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const { 2656 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2657 // place naturally. 2658 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 2659 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2660 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2661 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2662 2663 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 2664 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2665 } 2666 2667 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 2668 } 2669 2670 bool X86_64ABIInfo::IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2671 if (const VectorType *VecTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2672 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VecTy); 2673 unsigned LargestVector = getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel); 2674 if (Size <= 64 || Size > LargestVector) 2675 return true; 2676 } 2677 2678 return false; 2679 } 2680 2681 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, 2682 unsigned freeIntRegs) const { 2683 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2684 // place naturally. 2685 // 2686 // This assumption is optimistic, as there could be free registers available 2687 // when we need to pass this argument in memory, and LLVM could try to pass 2688 // the argument in the free register. This does not seem to happen currently, 2689 // but this code would be much safer if we could mark the argument with 2690 // 'onstack'. See PR12193. 2691 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !IsIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 2692 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2693 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2694 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2695 2696 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 2697 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2698 } 2699 2700 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 2701 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 2702 2703 // Compute the byval alignment. We specify the alignment of the byval in all 2704 // cases so that the mid-level optimizer knows the alignment of the byval. 2705 unsigned Align = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8, 8U); 2706 2707 // Attempt to avoid passing indirect results using byval when possible. This 2708 // is important for good codegen. 2709 // 2710 // We do this by coercing the value into a scalar type which the backend can 2711 // handle naturally (i.e., without using byval). 2712 // 2713 // For simplicity, we currently only do this when we have exhausted all of the 2714 // free integer registers. Doing this when there are free integer registers 2715 // would require more care, as we would have to ensure that the coerced value 2716 // did not claim the unused register. That would require either reording the 2717 // arguments to the function (so that any subsequent inreg values came first), 2718 // or only doing this optimization when there were no following arguments that 2719 // might be inreg. 2720 // 2721 // We currently expect it to be rare (particularly in well written code) for 2722 // arguments to be passed on the stack when there are still free integer 2723 // registers available (this would typically imply large structs being passed 2724 // by value), so this seems like a fair tradeoff for now. 2725 // 2726 // We can revisit this if the backend grows support for 'onstack' parameter 2727 // attributes. See PR12193. 2728 if (freeIntRegs == 0) { 2729 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2730 2731 // If this type fits in an eightbyte, coerce it into the matching integral 2732 // type, which will end up on the stack (with alignment 8). 2733 if (Align == 8 && Size <= 64) 2734 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2735 Size)); 2736 } 2737 2738 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)); 2739 } 2740 2741 /// The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in a full vector XMM/YMM 2742 /// register. Pick an LLVM IR type that will be passed as a vector register. 2743 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2744 // Wrapper structs/arrays that only contain vectors are passed just like 2745 // vectors; strip them off if present. 2746 if (const Type *InnerTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 2747 Ty = QualType(InnerTy, 0); 2748 2749 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 2750 if (isa<llvm::VectorType>(IRType) || 2751 IRType->getTypeID() == llvm::Type::FP128TyID) 2752 return IRType; 2753 2754 // We couldn't find the preferred IR vector type for 'Ty'. 2755 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2756 assert((Size == 128 || Size == 256 || Size == 512) && "Invalid type found!"); 2757 2758 // Return a LLVM IR vector type based on the size of 'Ty'. 2759 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()), 2760 Size / 64); 2761 } 2762 2763 /// BitsContainNoUserData - Return true if the specified [start,end) bit range 2764 /// is known to either be off the end of the specified type or being in 2765 /// alignment padding. The user type specified is known to be at most 128 bits 2766 /// in size, and have passed through X86_64ABIInfo::classify with a successful 2767 /// classification that put one of the two halves in the INTEGER class. 2768 /// 2769 /// It is conservatively correct to return false. 2770 static bool BitsContainNoUserData(QualType Ty, unsigned StartBit, 2771 unsigned EndBit, ASTContext &Context) { 2772 // If the bytes being queried are off the end of the type, there is no user 2773 // data hiding here. This handles analysis of builtins, vectors and other 2774 // types that don't contain interesting padding. 2775 unsigned TySize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 2776 if (TySize <= StartBit) 2777 return true; 2778 2779 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 2780 unsigned EltSize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 2781 unsigned NumElts = (unsigned)AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 2782 2783 // Check each element to see if the element overlaps with the queried range. 2784 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) { 2785 // If the element is after the span we care about, then we're done.. 2786 unsigned EltOffset = i*EltSize; 2787 if (EltOffset >= EndBit) break; 2788 2789 unsigned EltStart = EltOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-EltOffset :0; 2790 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(AT->getElementType(), EltStart, 2791 EndBit-EltOffset, Context)) 2792 return false; 2793 } 2794 // If it overlaps no elements, then it is safe to process as padding. 2795 return true; 2796 } 2797 2798 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2799 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2800 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2801 2802 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 2803 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2804 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 2805 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 2806 "Unexpected base class!"); 2807 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 2808 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2809 2810 // If the base is after the span we care about, ignore it. 2811 unsigned BaseOffset = Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 2812 if (BaseOffset >= EndBit) continue; 2813 2814 unsigned BaseStart = BaseOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-BaseOffset :0; 2815 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(I.getType(), BaseStart, 2816 EndBit-BaseOffset, Context)) 2817 return false; 2818 } 2819 } 2820 2821 // Verify that no field has data that overlaps the region of interest. Yes 2822 // this could be sped up a lot by being smarter about queried fields, 2823 // however we're only looking at structs up to 16 bytes, so we don't care 2824 // much. 2825 unsigned idx = 0; 2826 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 2827 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 2828 unsigned FieldOffset = (unsigned)Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2829 2830 // If we found a field after the region we care about, then we're done. 2831 if (FieldOffset >= EndBit) break; 2832 2833 unsigned FieldStart = FieldOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-FieldOffset :0; 2834 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(i->getType(), FieldStart, EndBit-FieldOffset, 2835 Context)) 2836 return false; 2837 } 2838 2839 // If nothing in this record overlapped the area of interest, then we're 2840 // clean. 2841 return true; 2842 } 2843 2844 return false; 2845 } 2846 2847 /// ContainsFloatAtOffset - Return true if the specified LLVM IR type has a 2848 /// float member at the specified offset. For example, {int,{float}} has a 2849 /// float at offset 4. It is conservatively correct for this routine to return 2850 /// false. 2851 static bool ContainsFloatAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 2852 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 2853 // Base case if we find a float. 2854 if (IROffset == 0 && IRType->isFloatTy()) 2855 return true; 2856 2857 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 2858 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 2859 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = TD.getStructLayout(STy); 2860 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 2861 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt); 2862 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(STy->getElementType(Elt), IROffset, TD); 2863 } 2864 2865 // If this is an array, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 2866 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 2867 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 2868 unsigned EltSize = TD.getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 2869 IROffset -= IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 2870 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset, TD); 2871 } 2872 2873 return false; 2874 } 2875 2876 2877 /// GetSSETypeAtOffset - Return a type that will be passed by the backend in the 2878 /// low 8 bytes of an XMM register, corresponding to the SSE class. 2879 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 2880 GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 2881 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 2882 // The only three choices we have are either double, <2 x float>, or float. We 2883 // pass as float if the last 4 bytes is just padding. This happens for 2884 // structs that contain 3 floats. 2885 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+32, 2886 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 2887 return llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 2888 2889 // We want to pass as <2 x float> if the LLVM IR type contains a float at 2890 // offset+0 and offset+4. Walk the LLVM IR type to find out if this is the 2891 // case. 2892 if (ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset, getDataLayout()) && 2893 ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset+4, getDataLayout())) 2894 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()), 2); 2895 2896 return llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 2897 } 2898 2899 2900 /// GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset - The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in 2901 /// an 8-byte GPR. This means that we either have a scalar or we are talking 2902 /// about the high or low part of an up-to-16-byte struct. This routine picks 2903 /// the best LLVM IR type to represent this, which may be i64 or may be anything 2904 /// else that the backend will pass in a GPR that works better (e.g. i8, %foo*, 2905 /// etc). 2906 /// 2907 /// PrefType is an LLVM IR type that corresponds to (part of) the IR type for 2908 /// the source type. IROffset is an offset in bytes into the LLVM IR type that 2909 /// the 8-byte value references. PrefType may be null. 2910 /// 2911 /// SourceTy is the source-level type for the entire argument. SourceOffset is 2912 /// an offset into this that we're processing (which is always either 0 or 8). 2913 /// 2914 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 2915 GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 2916 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 2917 // If we're dealing with an un-offset LLVM IR type, then it means that we're 2918 // returning an 8-byte unit starting with it. See if we can safely use it. 2919 if (IROffset == 0) { 2920 // Pointers and int64's always fill the 8-byte unit. 2921 if ((isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && Has64BitPointers) || 2922 IRType->isIntegerTy(64)) 2923 return IRType; 2924 2925 // If we have a 1/2/4-byte integer, we can use it only if the rest of the 2926 // goodness in the source type is just tail padding. This is allowed to 2927 // kick in for struct {double,int} on the int, but not on 2928 // struct{double,int,int} because we wouldn't return the second int. We 2929 // have to do this analysis on the source type because we can't depend on 2930 // unions being lowered a specific way etc. 2931 if (IRType->isIntegerTy(8) || IRType->isIntegerTy(16) || 2932 IRType->isIntegerTy(32) || 2933 (isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && !Has64BitPointers)) { 2934 unsigned BitWidth = isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) ? 32 : 2935 cast<llvm::IntegerType>(IRType)->getBitWidth(); 2936 2937 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+BitWidth, 2938 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 2939 return IRType; 2940 } 2941 } 2942 2943 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 2944 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 2945 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy); 2946 if (IROffset < SL->getSizeInBytes()) { 2947 unsigned FieldIdx = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 2948 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(FieldIdx); 2949 2950 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(STy->getElementType(FieldIdx), IROffset, 2951 SourceTy, SourceOffset); 2952 } 2953 } 2954 2955 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 2956 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 2957 unsigned EltSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 2958 unsigned EltOffset = IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 2959 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset-EltOffset, SourceTy, 2960 SourceOffset); 2961 } 2962 2963 // Okay, we don't have any better idea of what to pass, so we pass this in an 2964 // integer register that isn't too big to fit the rest of the struct. 2965 unsigned TySizeInBytes = 2966 (unsigned)getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(SourceTy).getQuantity(); 2967 2968 assert(TySizeInBytes != SourceOffset && "Empty field?"); 2969 2970 // It is always safe to classify this as an integer type up to i64 that 2971 // isn't larger than the structure. 2972 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2973 std::min(TySizeInBytes-SourceOffset, 8U)*8); 2974 } 2975 2976 2977 /// GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair - Given a high and low type that can ideally 2978 /// be used as elements of a two register pair to pass or return, return a 2979 /// first class aggregate to represent them. For example, if the low part of 2980 /// a by-value argument should be passed as i32* and the high part as float, 2981 /// return {i32*, float}. 2982 static llvm::Type * 2983 GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(llvm::Type *Lo, llvm::Type *Hi, 2984 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 2985 // In order to correctly satisfy the ABI, we need to the high part to start 2986 // at offset 8. If the high and low parts we inferred are both 4-byte types 2987 // (e.g. i32 and i32) then the resultant struct type ({i32,i32}) won't have 2988 // the second element at offset 8. Check for this: 2989 unsigned LoSize = (unsigned)TD.getTypeAllocSize(Lo); 2990 unsigned HiAlign = TD.getABITypeAlignment(Hi); 2991 unsigned HiStart = llvm::alignTo(LoSize, HiAlign); 2992 assert(HiStart != 0 && HiStart <= 8 && "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 2993 2994 // To handle this, we have to increase the size of the low part so that the 2995 // second element will start at an 8 byte offset. We can't increase the size 2996 // of the second element because it might make us access off the end of the 2997 // struct. 2998 if (HiStart != 8) { 2999 // There are usually two sorts of types the ABI generation code can produce 3000 // for the low part of a pair that aren't 8 bytes in size: float or 3001 // i8/i16/i32. This can also include pointers when they are 32-bit (X32 and 3002 // NaCl). 3003 // Promote these to a larger type. 3004 if (Lo->isFloatTy()) 3005 Lo = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(Lo->getContext()); 3006 else { 3007 assert((Lo->isIntegerTy() || Lo->isPointerTy()) 3008 && "Invalid/unknown lo type"); 3009 Lo = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Lo->getContext()); 3010 } 3011 } 3012 3013 llvm::StructType *Result = llvm::StructType::get(Lo, Hi, nullptr); 3014 3015 3016 // Verify that the second element is at an 8-byte offset. 3017 assert(TD.getStructLayout(Result)->getElementOffset(1) == 8 && 3018 "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 3019 return Result; 3020 } 3021 3022 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo:: 3023 classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 3024 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 1. Classify the return type with the 3025 // classification algorithm. 3026 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3027 classify(RetTy, 0, Lo, Hi, /*isNamedArg*/ true); 3028 3029 // Check some invariants. 3030 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3031 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3032 3033 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3034 switch (Lo) { 3035 case NoClass: 3036 if (Hi == NoClass) 3037 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3038 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3039 // null. 3040 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3041 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3042 break; 3043 3044 case SSEUp: 3045 case X87Up: 3046 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3047 3048 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 2. Types of class memory are returned via 3049 // hidden argument. 3050 case Memory: 3051 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy); 3052 3053 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 3. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3054 // available register of the sequence %rax, %rdx is used. 3055 case Integer: 3056 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3057 3058 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3059 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3060 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3061 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3062 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 3063 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3064 3065 if (RetTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3066 RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3067 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3068 } 3069 break; 3070 3071 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 4. If the class is SSE, the next 3072 // available SSE register of the sequence %xmm0, %xmm1 is used. 3073 case SSE: 3074 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3075 break; 3076 3077 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 6. If the class is X87, the value is 3078 // returned on the X87 stack in %st0 as 80-bit x87 number. 3079 case X87: 3080 ResType = llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()); 3081 break; 3082 3083 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 8. If the class is COMPLEX_X87, the real 3084 // part of the value is returned in %st0 and the imaginary part in 3085 // %st1. 3086 case ComplexX87: 3087 assert(Hi == ComplexX87 && "Unexpected ComplexX87 classification."); 3088 ResType = llvm::StructType::get(llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()), 3089 llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()), 3090 nullptr); 3091 break; 3092 } 3093 3094 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3095 switch (Hi) { 3096 // Memory was handled previously and X87 should 3097 // never occur as a hi class. 3098 case Memory: 3099 case X87: 3100 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3101 3102 case ComplexX87: // Previously handled. 3103 case NoClass: 3104 break; 3105 3106 case Integer: 3107 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3108 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3109 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3110 break; 3111 case SSE: 3112 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3113 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3114 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3115 break; 3116 3117 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 5. If the class is SSEUP, the eightbyte 3118 // is passed in the next available eightbyte chunk if the last used 3119 // vector register. 3120 // 3121 // SSEUP should always be preceded by SSE, just widen. 3122 case SSEUp: 3123 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification."); 3124 ResType = GetByteVectorType(RetTy); 3125 break; 3126 3127 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 7. If the class is X87UP, the value is 3128 // returned together with the previous X87 value in %st0. 3129 case X87Up: 3130 // If X87Up is preceded by X87, we don't need to do 3131 // anything. However, in some cases with unions it may not be 3132 // preceded by X87. In such situations we follow gcc and pass the 3133 // extra bits in an SSE reg. 3134 if (Lo != X87) { 3135 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3136 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3137 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3138 } 3139 break; 3140 } 3141 3142 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3143 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3144 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3145 if (HighPart) 3146 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3147 3148 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3149 } 3150 3151 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType( 3152 QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE, 3153 bool isNamedArg) 3154 const 3155 { 3156 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 3157 3158 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3159 classify(Ty, 0, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 3160 3161 // Check some invariants. 3162 // FIXME: Enforce these by construction. 3163 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3164 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3165 3166 neededInt = 0; 3167 neededSSE = 0; 3168 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3169 switch (Lo) { 3170 case NoClass: 3171 if (Hi == NoClass) 3172 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3173 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3174 // null. 3175 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3176 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3177 break; 3178 3179 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 1. If the class is MEMORY, pass the argument 3180 // on the stack. 3181 case Memory: 3182 3183 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 5. If the class is X87, X87UP or 3184 // COMPLEX_X87, it is passed in memory. 3185 case X87: 3186 case ComplexX87: 3187 if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()) == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) 3188 ++neededInt; 3189 return getIndirectResult(Ty, freeIntRegs); 3190 3191 case SSEUp: 3192 case X87Up: 3193 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3194 3195 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 2. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3196 // available register of the sequence %rdi, %rsi, %rdx, %rcx, %r8 3197 // and %r9 is used. 3198 case Integer: 3199 ++neededInt; 3200 3201 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3202 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 0, Ty, 0); 3203 3204 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3205 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3206 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3207 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3208 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3209 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3210 3211 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3212 Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3213 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3214 } 3215 3216 break; 3217 3218 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 3. If the class is SSE, the next 3219 // available SSE register is used, the registers are taken in the 3220 // order from %xmm0 to %xmm7. 3221 case SSE: { 3222 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3223 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(IRType, 0, Ty, 0); 3224 ++neededSSE; 3225 break; 3226 } 3227 } 3228 3229 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3230 switch (Hi) { 3231 // Memory was handled previously, ComplexX87 and X87 should 3232 // never occur as hi classes, and X87Up must be preceded by X87, 3233 // which is passed in memory. 3234 case Memory: 3235 case X87: 3236 case ComplexX87: 3237 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3238 3239 case NoClass: break; 3240 3241 case Integer: 3242 ++neededInt; 3243 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3244 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3245 3246 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3247 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3248 break; 3249 3250 // X87Up generally doesn't occur here (long double is passed in 3251 // memory), except in situations involving unions. 3252 case X87Up: 3253 case SSE: 3254 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3255 3256 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3257 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3258 3259 ++neededSSE; 3260 break; 3261 3262 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 4. If the class is SSEUP, the 3263 // eightbyte is passed in the upper half of the last used SSE 3264 // register. This only happens when 128-bit vectors are passed. 3265 case SSEUp: 3266 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification"); 3267 ResType = GetByteVectorType(Ty); 3268 break; 3269 } 3270 3271 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3272 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3273 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3274 if (HighPart) 3275 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3276 3277 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3278 } 3279 3280 void X86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 3281 3282 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 3283 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 3284 3285 // Keep track of the number of assigned registers. 3286 unsigned freeIntRegs = 6, freeSSERegs = 8; 3287 3288 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 3289 // integer register. 3290 if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) 3291 --freeIntRegs; 3292 3293 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 3294 if (FI.isChainCall()) 3295 ++freeIntRegs; 3296 3297 unsigned NumRequiredArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs(); 3298 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Once arguments are classified, the registers 3299 // get assigned (in left-to-right order) for passing as follows... 3300 unsigned ArgNo = 0; 3301 for (CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator it = FI.arg_begin(), ie = FI.arg_end(); 3302 it != ie; ++it, ++ArgNo) { 3303 bool IsNamedArg = ArgNo < NumRequiredArgs; 3304 3305 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 3306 it->info = classifyArgumentType(it->type, freeIntRegs, neededInt, 3307 neededSSE, IsNamedArg); 3308 3309 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: If there are no registers available for any 3310 // eightbyte of an argument, the whole argument is passed on the 3311 // stack. If registers have already been assigned for some 3312 // eightbytes of such an argument, the assignments get reverted. 3313 if (freeIntRegs >= neededInt && freeSSERegs >= neededSSE) { 3314 freeIntRegs -= neededInt; 3315 freeSSERegs -= neededSSE; 3316 } else { 3317 it->info = getIndirectResult(it->type, freeIntRegs); 3318 } 3319 } 3320 } 3321 3322 static Address EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3323 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) { 3324 Address overflow_arg_area_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 3325 VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), "overflow_arg_area_p"); 3326 llvm::Value *overflow_arg_area = 3327 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(overflow_arg_area_p, "overflow_arg_area"); 3328 3329 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 7. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to a 16 3330 // byte boundary if alignment needed by type exceeds 8 byte boundary. 3331 // It isn't stated explicitly in the standard, but in practice we use 3332 // alignment greater than 16 where necessary. 3333 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 3334 if (Align > CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)) { 3335 overflow_arg_area = emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, overflow_arg_area, 3336 Align); 3337 } 3338 3339 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 8. Fetch type from l->overflow_arg_area. 3340 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3341 llvm::Value *Res = 3342 CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(overflow_arg_area, 3343 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(LTy)); 3344 3345 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 9. Set l->overflow_arg_area to: 3346 // l->overflow_arg_area + sizeof(type). 3347 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 10. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to 3348 // an 8 byte boundary. 3349 3350 uint64_t SizeInBytes = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 7) / 8; 3351 llvm::Value *Offset = 3352 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (SizeInBytes + 7) & ~7); 3353 overflow_arg_area = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(overflow_arg_area, Offset, 3354 "overflow_arg_area.next"); 3355 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(overflow_arg_area, overflow_arg_area_p); 3356 3357 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 11. Return the fetched type. 3358 return Address(Res, Align); 3359 } 3360 3361 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3362 QualType Ty) const { 3363 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 3364 // struct { 3365 // i32 gp_offset; 3366 // i32 fp_offset; 3367 // i8* overflow_arg_area; 3368 // i8* reg_save_area; 3369 // }; 3370 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 3371 3372 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 3373 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 3374 /*isNamedArg*/false); 3375 3376 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 1. Determine whether type may be passed 3377 // in the registers. If not go to step 7. 3378 if (!neededInt && !neededSSE) 3379 return EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3380 3381 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 2. Compute num_gp to hold the number of 3382 // general purpose registers needed to pass type and num_fp to hold 3383 // the number of floating point registers needed. 3384 3385 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 3. Verify whether arguments fit into 3386 // registers. In the case: l->gp_offset > 48 - num_gp * 8 or 3387 // l->fp_offset > 304 - num_fp * 16 go to step 7. 3388 // 3389 // NOTE: 304 is a typo, there are (6 * 8 + 8 * 16) = 176 bytes of 3390 // register save space). 3391 3392 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 3393 Address gp_offset_p = Address::invalid(), fp_offset_p = Address::invalid(); 3394 llvm::Value *gp_offset = nullptr, *fp_offset = nullptr; 3395 if (neededInt) { 3396 gp_offset_p = 3397 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, CharUnits::Zero(), 3398 "gp_offset_p"); 3399 gp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(gp_offset_p, "gp_offset"); 3400 InRegs = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 48 - neededInt * 8); 3401 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(gp_offset, InRegs, "fits_in_gp"); 3402 } 3403 3404 if (neededSSE) { 3405 fp_offset_p = 3406 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 3407 "fp_offset_p"); 3408 fp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(fp_offset_p, "fp_offset"); 3409 llvm::Value *FitsInFP = 3410 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 176 - neededSSE * 16); 3411 FitsInFP = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(fp_offset, FitsInFP, "fits_in_fp"); 3412 InRegs = InRegs ? CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(InRegs, FitsInFP) : FitsInFP; 3413 } 3414 3415 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 3416 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 3417 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 3418 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 3419 3420 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 3421 3422 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 3423 3424 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 4. Fetch type from l->reg_save_area with 3425 // an offset of l->gp_offset and/or l->fp_offset. This may require 3426 // copying to a temporary location in case the parameter is passed 3427 // in different register classes or requires an alignment greater 3428 // than 8 for general purpose registers and 16 for XMM registers. 3429 // 3430 // FIXME: This really results in shameful code when we end up needing to 3431 // collect arguments from different places; often what should result in a 3432 // simple assembling of a structure from scattered addresses has many more 3433 // loads than necessary. Can we clean this up? 3434 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3435 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3436 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)), 3437 "reg_save_area"); 3438 3439 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 3440 if (neededInt && neededSSE) { 3441 // FIXME: Cleanup. 3442 assert(AI.isDirect() && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3443 llvm::StructType *ST = cast<llvm::StructType>(AI.getCoerceToType()); 3444 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3445 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3446 assert(ST->getNumElements() == 2 && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3447 llvm::Type *TyLo = ST->getElementType(0); 3448 llvm::Type *TyHi = ST->getElementType(1); 3449 assert((TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ^ TyHi->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) && 3450 "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3451 llvm::Type *PTyLo = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyLo); 3452 llvm::Type *PTyHi = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyHi); 3453 llvm::Value *GPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset); 3454 llvm::Value *FPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset); 3455 llvm::Value *RegLoAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? FPAddr : GPAddr; 3456 llvm::Value *RegHiAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? GPAddr : FPAddr; 3457 3458 // Copy the first element. 3459 llvm::Value *V = 3460 CGF.Builder.CreateDefaultAlignedLoad( 3461 CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegLoAddr, PTyLo)); 3462 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3463 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero())); 3464 3465 // Copy the second element. 3466 V = CGF.Builder.CreateDefaultAlignedLoad( 3467 CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegHiAddr, PTyHi)); 3468 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 3469 getDataLayout().getStructLayout(ST)->getElementOffset(1)); 3470 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, Offset)); 3471 3472 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3473 } else if (neededInt) { 3474 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset), 3475 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 3476 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3477 3478 // Copy to a temporary if necessary to ensure the appropriate alignment. 3479 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> SizeAlign = 3480 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 3481 uint64_t TySize = SizeAlign.first.getQuantity(); 3482 CharUnits TyAlign = SizeAlign.second; 3483 3484 // Copy into a temporary if the type is more aligned than the 3485 // register save area. 3486 if (TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 3487 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3488 CGF.Builder.CreateMemCpy(Tmp, RegAddr, TySize, false); 3489 RegAddr = Tmp; 3490 } 3491 3492 } else if (neededSSE == 1) { 3493 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3494 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3495 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3496 } else { 3497 assert(neededSSE == 2 && "Invalid number of needed registers!"); 3498 // SSE registers are spaced 16 bytes apart in the register save 3499 // area, we need to collect the two eightbytes together. 3500 // The ABI isn't explicit about this, but it seems reasonable 3501 // to assume that the slots are 16-byte aligned, since the stack is 3502 // naturally 16-byte aligned and the prologue is expected to store 3503 // all the SSE registers to the RSA. 3504 Address RegAddrLo = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3505 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3506 Address RegAddrHi = 3507 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddrLo, 3508 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3509 llvm::Type *DoubleTy = CGF.DoubleTy; 3510 llvm::StructType *ST = llvm::StructType::get(DoubleTy, DoubleTy, nullptr); 3511 llvm::Value *V; 3512 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3513 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3514 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3515 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrLo, DoubleTy)); 3516 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3517 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero())); 3518 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3519 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrHi, DoubleTy)); 3520 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3521 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8))); 3522 3523 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3524 } 3525 3526 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 5. Set: 3527 // l->gp_offset = l->gp_offset + num_gp * 8 3528 // l->fp_offset = l->fp_offset + num_fp * 16. 3529 if (neededInt) { 3530 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededInt * 8); 3531 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(gp_offset, Offset), 3532 gp_offset_p); 3533 } 3534 if (neededSSE) { 3535 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededSSE * 16); 3536 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(fp_offset, Offset), 3537 fp_offset_p); 3538 } 3539 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 3540 3541 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 3542 3543 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 3544 Address MemAddr = EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3545 3546 // Return the appropriate result. 3547 3548 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 3549 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, MemAddr, InMemBlock, 3550 "vaarg.addr"); 3551 return ResAddr; 3552 } 3553 3554 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3555 QualType Ty) const { 3556 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 3557 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 3558 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 3559 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 3560 } 3561 3562 ABIArgInfo WinX86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 3563 bool IsReturnType) const { 3564 3565 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 3566 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3567 3568 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3569 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3570 3571 TypeInfo Info = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty); 3572 uint64_t Width = Info.Width; 3573 CharUnits Align = getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align); 3574 3575 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 3576 if (RT) { 3577 if (!IsReturnType) { 3578 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 3579 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 3580 } 3581 3582 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 3583 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3584 3585 } 3586 3587 // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar to 3588 // other targets. 3589 const Type *Base = nullptr; 3590 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 3591 if (FreeSSERegs && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 3592 if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 3593 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3594 if (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 3595 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3596 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 3597 } 3598 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3599 } 3600 3601 3602 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3603 // If the member pointer is represented by an LLVM int or ptr, pass it 3604 // directly. 3605 llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3606 if (LLTy->isPointerTy() || LLTy->isIntegerTy()) 3607 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3608 } 3609 3610 if (RT || Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3611 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 3612 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 3613 if (Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width)) 3614 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3615 3616 // Otherwise, coerce it to a small integer. 3617 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Width)); 3618 } 3619 3620 // Bool type is always extended to the ABI, other builtin types are not 3621 // extended. 3622 const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3623 if (BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Bool) 3624 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3625 3626 // Mingw64 GCC uses the old 80 bit extended precision floating point unit. It 3627 // passes them indirectly through memory. 3628 if (IsMingw64 && BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 3629 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 3630 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended) 3631 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3632 } 3633 3634 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3635 } 3636 3637 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 3638 bool IsVectorCall = 3639 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall; 3640 3641 // We can use up to 4 SSE return registers with vectorcall. 3642 unsigned FreeSSERegs = IsVectorCall ? 4 : 0; 3643 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 3644 FI.getReturnInfo() = classify(FI.getReturnType(), FreeSSERegs, true); 3645 3646 // We can use up to 6 SSE register parameters with vectorcall. 3647 FreeSSERegs = IsVectorCall ? 6 : 0; 3648 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 3649 I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false); 3650 } 3651 3652 Address WinX86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3653 QualType Ty) const { 3654 3655 bool IsIndirect = false; 3656 3657 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 3658 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 3659 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3660 uint64_t Width = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 3661 IsIndirect = Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width); 3662 } 3663 3664 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 3665 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 3666 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 3667 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 3668 } 3669 3670 // PowerPC-32 3671 namespace { 3672 /// PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 32-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 3673 class PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 3674 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 3675 public: 3676 PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 3677 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {} 3678 3679 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3680 QualType Ty) const override; 3681 }; 3682 3683 class PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 3684 public: 3685 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 3686 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, SoftFloatABI)) {} 3687 3688 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 3689 // This is recovered from gcc output. 3690 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 3691 } 3692 3693 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3694 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 3695 }; 3696 3697 } 3698 3699 // TODO: this implementation is now likely redundant with 3700 // DefaultABIInfo::EmitVAArg. 3701 Address PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAList, 3702 QualType Ty) const { 3703 const unsigned OverflowLimit = 8; 3704 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 3705 // TODO: Implement this. For now ignore. 3706 (void)CTy; 3707 return Address::invalid(); // FIXME? 3708 } 3709 3710 // struct __va_list_tag { 3711 // unsigned char gpr; 3712 // unsigned char fpr; 3713 // unsigned short reserved; 3714 // void *overflow_arg_area; 3715 // void *reg_save_area; 3716 // }; 3717 3718 bool isI64 = Ty->isIntegerType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 3719 bool isInt = 3720 Ty->isIntegerType() || Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isAggregateType(); 3721 bool isF64 = Ty->isFloatingType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 3722 3723 // All aggregates are passed indirectly? That doesn't seem consistent 3724 // with the argument-lowering code. 3725 bool isIndirect = Ty->isAggregateType(); 3726 3727 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 3728 3729 // The calling convention either uses 1-2 GPRs or 1 FPR. 3730 Address NumRegsAddr = Address::invalid(); 3731 if (isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) { 3732 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 0, CharUnits::Zero(), "gpr"); 3733 } else { 3734 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 1, CharUnits::One(), "fpr"); 3735 } 3736 3737 llvm::Value *NumRegs = Builder.CreateLoad(NumRegsAddr, "numUsedRegs"); 3738 3739 // "Align" the register count when TY is i64. 3740 if (isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) { 3741 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(1)); 3742 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAnd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8((uint8_t) ~1U)); 3743 } 3744 3745 llvm::Value *CC = 3746 Builder.CreateICmpULT(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), "cond"); 3747 3748 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingRegs = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_regs"); 3749 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingOverflow = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_overflow"); 3750 llvm::BasicBlock *Cont = CGF.createBasicBlock("cont"); 3751 3752 Builder.CreateCondBr(CC, UsingRegs, UsingOverflow); 3753 3754 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 3755 if (isIndirect) DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 3756 3757 // Case 1: consume registers. 3758 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 3759 { 3760 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingRegs); 3761 3762 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = 3763 Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 3764 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr), 3765 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 3766 assert(RegAddr.getElementType() == CGF.Int8Ty); 3767 3768 // Floating-point registers start after the general-purpose registers. 3769 if (!(isInt || IsSoftFloatABI)) { 3770 RegAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddr, 3771 CharUnits::fromQuantity(32)); 3772 } 3773 3774 // Get the address of the saved value by scaling the number of 3775 // registers we've used by the number of 3776 CharUnits RegSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity((isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) ? 4 : 8); 3777 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 3778 Builder.CreateMul(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(RegSize.getQuantity())); 3779 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(CGF.Int8Ty, 3780 RegAddr.getPointer(), RegOffset), 3781 RegAddr.getAlignment().alignmentOfArrayElement(RegSize)); 3782 RegAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, DirectTy); 3783 3784 // Increase the used-register count. 3785 NumRegs = 3786 Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, 3787 Builder.getInt8((isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) ? 2 : 1)); 3788 Builder.CreateStore(NumRegs, NumRegsAddr); 3789 3790 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 3791 } 3792 3793 // Case 2: consume space in the overflow area. 3794 Address MemAddr = Address::invalid(); 3795 { 3796 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingOverflow); 3797 3798 Builder.CreateStore(Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), NumRegsAddr); 3799 3800 // Everything in the overflow area is rounded up to a size of at least 4. 3801 CharUnits OverflowAreaAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 3802 3803 CharUnits Size; 3804 if (!isIndirect) { 3805 auto TypeInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 3806 Size = TypeInfo.first.alignTo(OverflowAreaAlign); 3807 } else { 3808 Size = CGF.getPointerSize(); 3809 } 3810 3811 Address OverflowAreaAddr = 3812 Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 3813 Address OverflowArea(Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowAreaAddr, "argp.cur"), 3814 OverflowAreaAlign); 3815 // Round up address of argument to alignment 3816 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 3817 if (Align > OverflowAreaAlign) { 3818 llvm::Value *Ptr = OverflowArea.getPointer(); 3819 OverflowArea = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, Align), 3820 Align); 3821 } 3822 3823 MemAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArea, DirectTy); 3824 3825 // Increase the overflow area. 3826 OverflowArea = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OverflowArea, Size); 3827 Builder.CreateStore(OverflowArea.getPointer(), OverflowAreaAddr); 3828 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 3829 } 3830 3831 CGF.EmitBlock(Cont); 3832 3833 // Merge the cases with a phi. 3834 Address Result = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, UsingRegs, MemAddr, UsingOverflow, 3835 "vaarg.addr"); 3836 3837 // Load the pointer if the argument was passed indirectly. 3838 if (isIndirect) { 3839 Result = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Result, "aggr"), 3840 getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty)); 3841 } 3842 3843 return Result; 3844 } 3845 3846 bool 3847 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3848 llvm::Value *Address) const { 3849 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 3850 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 3851 3852 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 3853 3854 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 3855 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 3856 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 3857 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 3858 3859 // 0-31: r0-31, the 4-byte general-purpose registers 3860 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 31); 3861 3862 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 3863 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 3864 3865 // 64-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 3866 // 64: mq 3867 // 65: lr 3868 // 66: ctr 3869 // 67: ap 3870 // 68-75 cr0-7 3871 // 76: xer 3872 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 64, 76); 3873 3874 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 3875 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 3876 3877 // 109: vrsave 3878 // 110: vscr 3879 // 111: spe_acc 3880 // 112: spefscr 3881 // 113: sfp 3882 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 109, 113); 3883 3884 return false; 3885 } 3886 3887 // PowerPC-64 3888 3889 namespace { 3890 /// PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 64-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 3891 class PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 3892 public: 3893 enum ABIKind { 3894 ELFv1 = 0, 3895 ELFv2 3896 }; 3897 3898 private: 3899 static const unsigned GPRBits = 64; 3900 ABIKind Kind; 3901 bool HasQPX; 3902 3903 // A vector of float or double will be promoted to <4 x f32> or <4 x f64> and 3904 // will be passed in a QPX register. 3905 bool IsQPXVectorTy(const Type *Ty) const { 3906 if (!HasQPX) 3907 return false; 3908 3909 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3910 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 3911 if (NumElements == 1) 3912 return false; 3913 3914 if (VT->getElementType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) { 3915 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 256) 3916 return true; 3917 } else if (VT->getElementType()-> 3918 isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) { 3919 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128) 3920 return true; 3921 } 3922 } 3923 3924 return false; 3925 } 3926 3927 bool IsQPXVectorTy(QualType Ty) const { 3928 return IsQPXVectorTy(Ty.getTypePtr()); 3929 } 3930 3931 public: 3932 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX) 3933 : ABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind), HasQPX(HasQPX) {} 3934 3935 bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const; 3936 CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const; 3937 3938 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 3939 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 3940 3941 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 3942 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 3943 uint64_t Members) const override; 3944 3945 // TODO: We can add more logic to computeInfo to improve performance. 3946 // Example: For aggregate arguments that fit in a register, we could 3947 // use getDirectInReg (as is done below for structs containing a single 3948 // floating-point value) to avoid pushing them to memory on function 3949 // entry. This would require changing the logic in PPCISelLowering 3950 // when lowering the parameters in the caller and args in the callee. 3951 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 3952 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 3953 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 3954 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 3955 // We rely on the default argument classification for the most part. 3956 // One exception: An aggregate containing a single floating-point 3957 // or vector item must be passed in a register if one is available. 3958 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(I.type, getContext()); 3959 if (T) { 3960 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3961 if (IsQPXVectorTy(T) || 3962 (T->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(T) == 128) || 3963 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) { 3964 QualType QT(T, 0); 3965 I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CGT.ConvertType(QT)); 3966 continue; 3967 } 3968 } 3969 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 3970 } 3971 } 3972 3973 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3974 QualType Ty) const override; 3975 }; 3976 3977 class PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 3978 3979 public: 3980 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, 3981 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX) 3982 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, Kind, HasQPX)) {} 3983 3984 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 3985 // This is recovered from gcc output. 3986 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 3987 } 3988 3989 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3990 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 3991 }; 3992 3993 class PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 3994 public: 3995 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 3996 3997 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 3998 // This is recovered from gcc output. 3999 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4000 } 4001 4002 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4003 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4004 }; 4005 4006 } 4007 4008 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero- 4009 // extended to 64 bits. 4010 bool 4011 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const { 4012 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4013 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 4014 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4015 4016 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 4017 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 4018 return true; 4019 4020 // In addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also need to 4021 // extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64 bits. 4022 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 4023 switch (BT->getKind()) { 4024 case BuiltinType::Int: 4025 case BuiltinType::UInt: 4026 return true; 4027 default: 4028 break; 4029 } 4030 4031 return false; 4032 } 4033 4034 /// isAlignedParamType - Determine whether a type requires 16-byte or 4035 /// higher alignment in the parameter area. Always returns at least 8. 4036 CharUnits PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const { 4037 // Complex types are passed just like their elements. 4038 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4039 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 4040 4041 // Only vector types of size 16 bytes need alignment (larger types are 4042 // passed via reference, smaller types are not aligned). 4043 if (IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4044 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 128) 4045 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4046 4047 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4048 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 4049 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 : 8); 4050 } 4051 4052 // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type 4053 // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element. 4054 const Type *AlignAsType = nullptr; 4055 const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 4056 if (EltType) { 4057 const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4058 if (IsQPXVectorTy(EltType) || (EltType->isVectorType() && 4059 getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) || 4060 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) 4061 AlignAsType = EltType; 4062 } 4063 4064 // Likewise for ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates. 4065 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4066 uint64_t Members = 0; 4067 if (!AlignAsType && Kind == ELFv2 && 4068 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) 4069 AlignAsType = Base; 4070 4071 // With special case aggregates, only vector base types need alignment. 4072 if (AlignAsType && IsQPXVectorTy(AlignAsType)) { 4073 if (getContext().getTypeSize(AlignAsType) > 128) 4074 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4075 4076 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4077 } else if (AlignAsType) { 4078 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignAsType->isVectorType() ? 16 : 8); 4079 } 4080 4081 // Otherwise, we only need alignment for any aggregate type that 4082 // has an alignment requirement of >= 16 bytes. 4083 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 128) { 4084 if (HasQPX && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 256) 4085 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4086 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4087 } 4088 4089 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4090 } 4091 4092 /// isHomogeneousAggregate - Return true if a type is an ELFv2 homogeneous 4093 /// aggregate. Base is set to the base element type, and Members is set 4094 /// to the number of base elements. 4095 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *&Base, 4096 uint64_t &Members) const { 4097 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 4098 uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4099 if (NElements == 0) 4100 return false; 4101 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(AT->getElementType(), Base, Members)) 4102 return false; 4103 Members *= NElements; 4104 } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 4105 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 4106 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 4107 return false; 4108 4109 Members = 0; 4110 4111 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 4112 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 4113 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 4114 // Ignore empty records. 4115 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), I.getType(), true)) 4116 continue; 4117 4118 uint64_t FldMembers; 4119 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(I.getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4120 return false; 4121 4122 Members += FldMembers; 4123 } 4124 } 4125 4126 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 4127 // Ignore (non-zero arrays of) empty records. 4128 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 4129 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = 4130 getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 4131 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() == 0) 4132 return false; 4133 FT = AT->getElementType(); 4134 } 4135 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FT, true)) 4136 continue; 4137 4138 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 4139 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4140 FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0) 4141 continue; 4142 4143 uint64_t FldMembers; 4144 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(FD->getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4145 return false; 4146 4147 Members = (RD->isUnion() ? 4148 std::max(Members, FldMembers) : Members + FldMembers); 4149 } 4150 4151 if (!Base) 4152 return false; 4153 4154 // Ensure there is no padding. 4155 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) * Members != 4156 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty)) 4157 return false; 4158 } else { 4159 Members = 1; 4160 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4161 Members = 2; 4162 Ty = CT->getElementType(); 4163 } 4164 4165 // Most ABIs only support float, double, and some vector type widths. 4166 if (!isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(Ty)) 4167 return false; 4168 4169 // The base type must be the same for all members. Types that 4170 // agree in both total size and mode (float vs. vector) are 4171 // treated as being equivalent here. 4172 const Type *TyPtr = Ty.getTypePtr(); 4173 if (!Base) { 4174 Base = TyPtr; 4175 // If it's a non-power-of-2 vector, its size is already a power-of-2, 4176 // so make sure to widen it explicitly. 4177 if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4178 QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType(); 4179 unsigned NumElements = 4180 getContext().getTypeSize(VT) / getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy); 4181 Base = getContext() 4182 .getVectorType(EltTy, NumElements, VT->getVectorKind()) 4183 .getTypePtr(); 4184 } 4185 } 4186 4187 if (Base->isVectorType() != TyPtr->isVectorType() || 4188 getContext().getTypeSize(Base) != getContext().getTypeSize(TyPtr)) 4189 return false; 4190 } 4191 return Members > 0 && isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(Base, Members); 4192 } 4193 4194 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 4195 // Homogeneous aggregates for ELFv2 must have base types of float, 4196 // double, long double, or 128-bit vectors. 4197 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 4198 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 4199 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 4200 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) 4201 return true; 4202 } 4203 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4204 if (getContext().getTypeSize(VT) == 128 || IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) 4205 return true; 4206 } 4207 return false; 4208 } 4209 4210 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough( 4211 const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const { 4212 // Vector types require one register, floating point types require one 4213 // or two registers depending on their size. 4214 uint32_t NumRegs = 4215 Base->isVectorType() ? 1 : (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 63) / 64; 4216 4217 // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 8 registers. 4218 return Members * NumRegs <= 8; 4219 } 4220 4221 ABIArgInfo 4222 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 4223 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 4224 4225 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) 4226 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4227 4228 // Non-Altivec vector types are passed in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4229 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4230 if (Ty->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4231 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4232 if (Size > 128) 4233 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4234 else if (Size < 128) { 4235 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4236 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4237 } 4238 } 4239 4240 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 4241 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 4242 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 4243 4244 uint64_t ABIAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty).getQuantity(); 4245 uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity(); 4246 4247 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are passed as array types. 4248 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4249 uint64_t Members = 0; 4250 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4251 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 4252 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4253 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4254 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4255 } 4256 4257 // If an aggregate may end up fully in registers, we do not 4258 // use the ByVal method, but pass the aggregate as array. 4259 // This is usually beneficial since we avoid forcing the 4260 // back-end to store the argument to memory. 4261 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4262 if (Bits > 0 && Bits <= 8 * GPRBits) { 4263 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4264 4265 // Types up to 8 bytes are passed as integer type (which will be 4266 // properly aligned in the argument save area doubleword). 4267 if (Bits <= GPRBits) 4268 CoerceTy = 4269 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4270 // Larger types are passed as arrays, with the base type selected 4271 // according to the required alignment in the save area. 4272 else { 4273 uint64_t RegBits = ABIAlign * 8; 4274 uint64_t NumRegs = llvm::alignTo(Bits, RegBits) / RegBits; 4275 llvm::Type *RegTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), RegBits); 4276 CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(RegTy, NumRegs); 4277 } 4278 4279 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4280 } 4281 4282 // All other aggregates are passed ByVal. 4283 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 4284 /*ByVal=*/true, 4285 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 4286 } 4287 4288 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ? 4289 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4290 } 4291 4292 ABIArgInfo 4293 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 4294 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 4295 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4296 4297 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 4298 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4299 4300 // Non-Altivec vector types are returned in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4301 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4302 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(RetTy)) { 4303 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4304 if (Size > 128) 4305 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4306 else if (Size < 128) { 4307 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4308 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4309 } 4310 } 4311 4312 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 4313 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are returned as array types. 4314 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4315 uint64_t Members = 0; 4316 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4317 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) { 4318 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4319 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4320 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4321 } 4322 4323 // ELFv2 small aggregates are returned in up to two registers. 4324 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4325 if (Kind == ELFv2 && Bits <= 2 * GPRBits) { 4326 if (Bits == 0) 4327 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4328 4329 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4330 if (Bits > GPRBits) { 4331 CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), GPRBits); 4332 CoerceTy = llvm::StructType::get(CoerceTy, CoerceTy, nullptr); 4333 } else 4334 CoerceTy = 4335 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4336 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4337 } 4338 4339 // All other aggregates are returned indirectly. 4340 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4341 } 4342 4343 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ? 4344 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4345 } 4346 4347 // Based on ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg, adjusted for 64-bit machine. 4348 Address PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4349 QualType Ty) const { 4350 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4351 TypeInfo.second = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty); 4352 4353 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4354 4355 // If we have a complex type and the base type is smaller than 8 bytes, 4356 // the ABI calls for the real and imaginary parts to be right-adjusted 4357 // in separate doublewords. However, Clang expects us to produce a 4358 // pointer to a structure with the two parts packed tightly. So generate 4359 // loads of the real and imaginary parts relative to the va_list pointer, 4360 // and store them to a temporary structure. 4361 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4362 CharUnits EltSize = TypeInfo.first / 2; 4363 if (EltSize < SlotSize) { 4364 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, CGF.Int8Ty, 4365 SlotSize * 2, SlotSize, 4366 SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4367 4368 Address RealAddr = Addr; 4369 Address ImagAddr = RealAddr; 4370 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) { 4371 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, 4372 SlotSize - EltSize); 4373 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(ImagAddr, 4374 2 * SlotSize - EltSize); 4375 } else { 4376 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, SlotSize); 4377 } 4378 4379 llvm::Type *EltTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(CTy->getElementType()); 4380 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RealAddr, EltTy); 4381 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(ImagAddr, EltTy); 4382 llvm::Value *Real = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RealAddr, ".vareal"); 4383 llvm::Value *Imag = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ImagAddr, ".vaimag"); 4384 4385 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "vacplx"); 4386 CGF.EmitStoreOfComplex({Real, Imag}, CGF.MakeAddrLValue(Temp, Ty), 4387 /*init*/ true); 4388 return Temp; 4389 } 4390 } 4391 4392 // Otherwise, just use the general rule. 4393 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 4394 TypeInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4395 } 4396 4397 static bool 4398 PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4399 llvm::Value *Address) { 4400 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 4401 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 4402 4403 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4404 4405 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 4406 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 4407 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 4408 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 4409 4410 // 0-31: r0-31, the 8-byte general-purpose registers 4411 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 4412 4413 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 4414 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 4415 4416 // 64-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 4417 // 64: mq 4418 // 65: lr 4419 // 66: ctr 4420 // 67: ap 4421 // 68-75 cr0-7 4422 // 76: xer 4423 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 64, 76); 4424 4425 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 4426 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 4427 4428 // 109: vrsave 4429 // 110: vscr 4430 // 111: spe_acc 4431 // 112: spefscr 4432 // 113: sfp 4433 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 109, 113); 4434 4435 return false; 4436 } 4437 4438 bool 4439 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 4440 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4441 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4442 4443 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4444 } 4445 4446 bool 4447 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4448 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4449 4450 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4451 } 4452 4453 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4454 // AArch64 ABI Implementation 4455 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4456 4457 namespace { 4458 4459 class AArch64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 4460 public: 4461 enum ABIKind { 4462 AAPCS = 0, 4463 DarwinPCS 4464 }; 4465 4466 private: 4467 ABIKind Kind; 4468 4469 public: 4470 AArch64ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind) 4471 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {} 4472 4473 private: 4474 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 4475 bool isDarwinPCS() const { return Kind == DarwinPCS; } 4476 4477 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 4478 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 4479 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 4480 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 4481 uint64_t Members) const override; 4482 4483 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 4484 4485 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 4486 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 4487 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 4488 4489 for (auto &it : FI.arguments()) 4490 it.info = classifyArgumentType(it.type); 4491 } 4492 4493 Address EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4494 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4495 4496 Address EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4497 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4498 4499 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4500 QualType Ty) const override { 4501 return isDarwinPCS() ? EmitDarwinVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF) 4502 : EmitAAPCSVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF); 4503 } 4504 4505 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 4506 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 4507 bool asReturnValue) const override { 4508 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 4509 } 4510 }; 4511 4512 class AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4513 public: 4514 AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind) 4515 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AArch64ABIInfo(CGT, Kind)) {} 4516 4517 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 4518 return "mov\tfp, fp\t\t; marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 4519 } 4520 4521 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4522 return 31; 4523 } 4524 4525 bool doesReturnSlotInterfereWithArgs() const override { return false; } 4526 }; 4527 } 4528 4529 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 4530 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 4531 4532 // Handle illegal vector types here. 4533 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 4534 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4535 // Android promotes <2 x i8> to i16, not i32 4536 if (isAndroid() && (Size <= 16)) { 4537 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()); 4538 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4539 } 4540 if (Size <= 32) { 4541 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 4542 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4543 } 4544 if (Size == 64) { 4545 llvm::Type *ResType = 4546 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2); 4547 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4548 } 4549 if (Size == 128) { 4550 llvm::Type *ResType = 4551 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4); 4552 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4553 } 4554 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4555 } 4556 4557 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 4558 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4559 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 4560 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4561 4562 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 4563 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 4564 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4565 } 4566 4567 // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial 4568 // copy constructor are always indirect. 4569 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 4570 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA == 4571 CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 4572 } 4573 4574 // Empty records are always ignored on Darwin, but actually passed in C++ mode 4575 // elsewhere for GNU compatibility. 4576 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 4577 if (!getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isDarwinPCS()) 4578 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4579 4580 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 4581 } 4582 4583 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) need to be expanded. 4584 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4585 uint64_t Members = 0; 4586 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 4587 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 4588 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members)); 4589 } 4590 4591 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are passed directly in registers or on the stack. 4592 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4593 if (Size <= 128) { 4594 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 4595 // same size and alignment. 4596 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 4597 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 4598 } 4599 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty); 4600 Size = 64 * ((Size + 63) / 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 4601 4602 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 4603 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 4604 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 4605 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 4606 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 4607 } 4608 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 4609 } 4610 4611 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4612 } 4613 4614 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 4615 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 4616 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4617 4618 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 4619 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) 4620 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4621 4622 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 4623 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4624 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 4625 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4626 4627 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 4628 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 4629 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4630 } 4631 4632 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 4633 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4634 4635 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4636 uint64_t Members = 0; 4637 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) 4638 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) are returned directly. 4639 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4640 4641 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are returned directly in registers or on the stack. 4642 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4643 if (Size <= 128) { 4644 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 4645 // same size and alignment. 4646 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 4647 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 4648 } 4649 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(RetTy); 4650 Size = 64 * ((Size + 63) / 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 4651 4652 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 4653 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 4654 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 4655 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 4656 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 4657 } 4658 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 4659 } 4660 4661 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4662 } 4663 4664 /// isIllegalVectorType - check whether the vector type is legal for AArch64. 4665 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 4666 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4667 // Check whether VT is legal. 4668 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 4669 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 4670 // NumElements should be power of 2. 4671 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 4672 return true; 4673 return Size != 64 && (Size != 128 || NumElements == 1); 4674 } 4675 return false; 4676 } 4677 4678 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 4679 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS64 must have base types of a floating 4680 // point type or a short-vector type. This is the same as the 32-bit ABI, 4681 // but with the difference that any floating-point type is allowed, 4682 // including __fp16. 4683 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 4684 if (BT->isFloatingPoint()) 4685 return true; 4686 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4687 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 4688 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 4689 return true; 4690 } 4691 return false; 4692 } 4693 4694 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 4695 uint64_t Members) const { 4696 return Members <= 4; 4697 } 4698 4699 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, 4700 QualType Ty, 4701 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 4702 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 4703 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 4704 4705 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 4706 if (IsIndirect) 4707 BaseTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(BaseTy); 4708 else if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 4709 BaseTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 4710 4711 unsigned NumRegs = 1; 4712 if (llvm::ArrayType *ArrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(BaseTy)) { 4713 BaseTy = ArrTy->getElementType(); 4714 NumRegs = ArrTy->getNumElements(); 4715 } 4716 bool IsFPR = BaseTy->isFloatingPointTy() || BaseTy->isVectorTy(); 4717 4718 // The AArch64 va_list type and handling is specified in the Procedure Call 4719 // Standard, section B.4: 4720 // 4721 // struct { 4722 // void *__stack; 4723 // void *__gr_top; 4724 // void *__vr_top; 4725 // int __gr_offs; 4726 // int __vr_offs; 4727 // }; 4728 4729 llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg"); 4730 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 4731 llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack"); 4732 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 4733 4734 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4735 CharUnits TyAlign = TyInfo.second; 4736 4737 Address reg_offs_p = Address::invalid(); 4738 llvm::Value *reg_offs = nullptr; 4739 int reg_top_index; 4740 CharUnits reg_top_offset; 4741 int RegSize = IsIndirect ? 8 : TyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 4742 if (!IsFPR) { 4743 // 3 is the field number of __gr_offs 4744 reg_offs_p = 4745 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24), 4746 "gr_offs_p"); 4747 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "gr_offs"); 4748 reg_top_index = 1; // field number for __gr_top 4749 reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4750 RegSize = llvm::alignTo(RegSize, 8); 4751 } else { 4752 // 4 is the field number of __vr_offs. 4753 reg_offs_p = 4754 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(28), 4755 "vr_offs_p"); 4756 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "vr_offs"); 4757 reg_top_index = 2; // field number for __vr_top 4758 reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4759 RegSize = 16 * NumRegs; 4760 } 4761 4762 //======================================= 4763 // Find out where argument was passed 4764 //======================================= 4765 4766 // If reg_offs >= 0 we're already using the stack for this type of 4767 // argument. We don't want to keep updating reg_offs (in case it overflows, 4768 // though anyone passing 2GB of arguments, each at most 16 bytes, deserves 4769 // whatever they get). 4770 llvm::Value *UsingStack = nullptr; 4771 UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGE( 4772 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0)); 4773 4774 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, MaybeRegBlock); 4775 4776 // Otherwise, at least some kind of argument could go in these registers, the 4777 // question is whether this particular type is too big. 4778 CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock); 4779 4780 // Integer arguments may need to correct register alignment (for example a 4781 // "struct { __int128 a; };" gets passed in x_2N, x_{2N+1}). In this case we 4782 // align __gr_offs to calculate the potential address. 4783 if (!IsFPR && !IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 4784 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 4785 4786 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 4787 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Align - 1), 4788 "align_regoffs"); 4789 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 4790 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -Align), 4791 "aligned_regoffs"); 4792 } 4793 4794 // Update the gr_offs/vr_offs pointer for next call to va_arg on this va_list. 4795 // The fact that this is done unconditionally reflects the fact that 4796 // allocating an argument to the stack also uses up all the remaining 4797 // registers of the appropriate kind. 4798 llvm::Value *NewOffset = nullptr; 4799 NewOffset = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 4800 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, RegSize), "new_reg_offs"); 4801 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOffset, reg_offs_p); 4802 4803 // Now we're in a position to decide whether this argument really was in 4804 // registers or not. 4805 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 4806 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSLE( 4807 NewOffset, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0), "inreg"); 4808 4809 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, OnStackBlock); 4810 4811 //======================================= 4812 // Argument was in registers 4813 //======================================= 4814 4815 // Now we emit the code for if the argument was originally passed in 4816 // registers. First start the appropriate block: 4817 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 4818 4819 llvm::Value *reg_top = nullptr; 4820 Address reg_top_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, reg_top_index, 4821 reg_top_offset, "reg_top_p"); 4822 reg_top = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_top_p, "reg_top"); 4823 Address BaseAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(reg_top, reg_offs), 4824 CharUnits::fromQuantity(IsFPR ? 16 : 8)); 4825 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 4826 llvm::Type *MemTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 4827 4828 if (IsIndirect) { 4829 // If it's been passed indirectly (actually a struct), whatever we find from 4830 // stored registers or on the stack will actually be a struct **. 4831 MemTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(MemTy); 4832 } 4833 4834 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4835 uint64_t NumMembers = 0; 4836 bool IsHFA = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumMembers); 4837 if (IsHFA && NumMembers > 1) { 4838 // Homogeneous aggregates passed in registers will have their elements split 4839 // and stored 16-bytes apart regardless of size (they're notionally in qN, 4840 // qN+1, ...). We reload and store into a temporary local variable 4841 // contiguously. 4842 assert(!IsIndirect && "Homogeneous aggregates should be passed directly"); 4843 auto BaseTyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(QualType(Base, 0)); 4844 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4845 llvm::Type *HFATy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, NumMembers); 4846 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateTempAlloca(HFATy, 4847 std::max(TyAlign, BaseTyInfo.second)); 4848 4849 // On big-endian platforms, the value will be right-aligned in its slot. 4850 int Offset = 0; 4851 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 4852 BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity() < 16) 4853 Offset = 16 - BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 4854 4855 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumMembers; ++i) { 4856 CharUnits BaseOffset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16 * i + Offset); 4857 Address LoadAddr = 4858 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, BaseOffset); 4859 LoadAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(LoadAddr, BaseTy); 4860 4861 Address StoreAddr = 4862 CGF.Builder.CreateConstArrayGEP(Tmp, i, BaseTyInfo.first); 4863 4864 llvm::Value *Elem = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(LoadAddr); 4865 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Elem, StoreAddr); 4866 } 4867 4868 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, MemTy); 4869 } else { 4870 // Otherwise the object is contiguous in memory. 4871 4872 // It might be right-aligned in its slot. 4873 CharUnits SlotSize = BaseAddr.getAlignment(); 4874 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !IsIndirect && 4875 (IsHFA || !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) && 4876 TyInfo.first < SlotSize) { 4877 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TyInfo.first; 4878 BaseAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, Offset); 4879 } 4880 4881 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(BaseAddr, MemTy); 4882 } 4883 4884 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 4885 4886 //======================================= 4887 // Argument was on the stack 4888 //======================================= 4889 CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock); 4890 4891 Address stack_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, 4892 CharUnits::Zero(), "stack_p"); 4893 llvm::Value *OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(stack_p, "stack"); 4894 4895 // Again, stack arguments may need realignment. In this case both integer and 4896 // floating-point ones might be affected. 4897 if (!IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 4898 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 4899 4900 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int64Ty); 4901 4902 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 4903 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1), 4904 "align_stack"); 4905 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 4906 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, -Align), 4907 "align_stack"); 4908 4909 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 4910 } 4911 Address OnStackAddr(OnStackPtr, 4912 std::max(CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), TyAlign)); 4913 4914 // All stack slots are multiples of 8 bytes. 4915 CharUnits StackSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4916 CharUnits StackSize; 4917 if (IsIndirect) 4918 StackSize = StackSlotSize; 4919 else 4920 StackSize = TyInfo.first.alignTo(StackSlotSize); 4921 4922 llvm::Value *StackSizeC = CGF.Builder.getSize(StackSize); 4923 llvm::Value *NewStack = 4924 CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(OnStackPtr, StackSizeC, "new_stack"); 4925 4926 // Write the new value of __stack for the next call to va_arg 4927 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewStack, stack_p); 4928 4929 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && 4930 TyInfo.first < StackSlotSize) { 4931 CharUnits Offset = StackSlotSize - TyInfo.first; 4932 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OnStackAddr, Offset); 4933 } 4934 4935 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OnStackAddr, MemTy); 4936 4937 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 4938 4939 //======================================= 4940 // Tidy up 4941 //======================================= 4942 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 4943 4944 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 4945 OnStackAddr, OnStackBlock, "vaargs.addr"); 4946 4947 if (IsIndirect) 4948 return Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "vaarg.addr"), 4949 TyInfo.second); 4950 4951 return ResAddr; 4952 } 4953 4954 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4955 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 4956 // The backend's lowering doesn't support va_arg for aggregates or 4957 // illegal vector types. Lower VAArg here for these cases and use 4958 // the LLVM va_arg instruction for everything else. 4959 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) 4960 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4961 4962 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4963 4964 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 4965 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 4966 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 4967 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 4968 return Addr; 4969 } 4970 4971 // The size of the actual thing passed, which might end up just 4972 // being a pointer for indirect types. 4973 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4974 4975 // Arguments bigger than 16 bytes which aren't homogeneous 4976 // aggregates should be passed indirectly. 4977 bool IsIndirect = false; 4978 if (TyInfo.first.getQuantity() > 16) { 4979 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4980 uint64_t Members = 0; 4981 IsIndirect = !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members); 4982 } 4983 4984 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 4985 TyInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 4986 } 4987 4988 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4989 // ARM ABI Implementation 4990 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4991 4992 namespace { 4993 4994 class ARMABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 4995 public: 4996 enum ABIKind { 4997 APCS = 0, 4998 AAPCS = 1, 4999 AAPCS_VFP = 2, 5000 AAPCS16_VFP = 3, 5001 }; 5002 5003 private: 5004 ABIKind Kind; 5005 5006 public: 5007 ARMABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind _Kind) 5008 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(_Kind) { 5009 setCCs(); 5010 } 5011 5012 bool isEABI() const { 5013 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5014 case llvm::Triple::Android: 5015 case llvm::Triple::EABI: 5016 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5017 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABI: 5018 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5019 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABI: 5020 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5021 return true; 5022 default: 5023 return false; 5024 } 5025 } 5026 5027 bool isEABIHF() const { 5028 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5029 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5030 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5031 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5032 return true; 5033 default: 5034 return false; 5035 } 5036 } 5037 5038 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 5039 5040 private: 5041 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5042 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5043 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 5044 5045 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 5046 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 5047 uint64_t Members) const override; 5048 5049 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 5050 5051 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5052 QualType Ty) const override; 5053 5054 llvm::CallingConv::ID getLLVMDefaultCC() const; 5055 llvm::CallingConv::ID getABIDefaultCC() const; 5056 void setCCs(); 5057 5058 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 5059 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 5060 bool asReturnValue) const override { 5061 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 5062 } 5063 }; 5064 5065 class ARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 5066 public: 5067 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5068 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new ARMABIInfo(CGT, K)) {} 5069 5070 const ARMABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 5071 return static_cast<const ARMABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 5072 } 5073 5074 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 5075 return 13; 5076 } 5077 5078 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 5079 return "mov\tr7, r7\t\t@ marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 5080 } 5081 5082 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 5083 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 5084 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 5085 5086 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 5087 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 15); 5088 return false; 5089 } 5090 5091 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 5092 if (getABIInfo().isEABI()) return 88; 5093 return TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException(); 5094 } 5095 5096 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5097 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 5098 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 5099 if (!FD) 5100 return; 5101 5102 const ARMInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>(); 5103 if (!Attr) 5104 return; 5105 5106 const char *Kind; 5107 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 5108 case ARMInterruptAttr::Generic: Kind = ""; break; 5109 case ARMInterruptAttr::IRQ: Kind = "IRQ"; break; 5110 case ARMInterruptAttr::FIQ: Kind = "FIQ"; break; 5111 case ARMInterruptAttr::SWI: Kind = "SWI"; break; 5112 case ARMInterruptAttr::ABORT: Kind = "ABORT"; break; 5113 case ARMInterruptAttr::UNDEF: Kind = "UNDEF"; break; 5114 } 5115 5116 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 5117 5118 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 5119 5120 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind ABI = cast<ARMABIInfo>(getABIInfo()).getABIKind(); 5121 if (ABI == ARMABIInfo::APCS) 5122 return; 5123 5124 // AAPCS guarantees that sp will be 8-byte aligned on any public interface, 5125 // however this is not necessarily true on taking any interrupt. Instruct 5126 // the backend to perform a realignment as part of the function prologue. 5127 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 5128 B.addStackAlignmentAttr(8); 5129 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeSet::FunctionIndex, 5130 llvm::AttributeSet::get(CGM.getLLVMContext(), 5131 llvm::AttributeSet::FunctionIndex, 5132 B)); 5133 } 5134 }; 5135 5136 class WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public ARMTargetCodeGenInfo { 5137 public: 5138 WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5139 : ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {} 5140 5141 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5142 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 5143 5144 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 5145 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 5146 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 5147 } 5148 5149 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value, 5150 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 5151 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 5152 } 5153 }; 5154 5155 void WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 5156 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 5157 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5158 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 5159 } 5160 } 5161 5162 void ARMABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 5163 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 5164 FI.getReturnInfo() = 5165 classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic()); 5166 5167 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 5168 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, FI.isVariadic()); 5169 5170 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 5171 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5172 return; 5173 5174 llvm::CallingConv::ID cc = getRuntimeCC(); 5175 if (cc != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5176 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(cc); 5177 } 5178 5179 /// Return the default calling convention that LLVM will use. 5180 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getLLVMDefaultCC() const { 5181 // The default calling convention that LLVM will infer. 5182 if (isEABIHF() || getTarget().getTriple().isWatchABI()) 5183 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5184 else if (isEABI()) 5185 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5186 else 5187 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5188 } 5189 5190 /// Return the calling convention that our ABI would like us to use 5191 /// as the C calling convention. 5192 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getABIDefaultCC() const { 5193 switch (getABIKind()) { 5194 case APCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5195 case AAPCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5196 case AAPCS_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5197 case AAPCS16_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5198 } 5199 llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind"); 5200 } 5201 5202 void ARMABIInfo::setCCs() { 5203 assert(getRuntimeCC() == llvm::CallingConv::C); 5204 5205 // Don't muddy up the IR with a ton of explicit annotations if 5206 // they'd just match what LLVM will infer from the triple. 5207 llvm::CallingConv::ID abiCC = getABIDefaultCC(); 5208 if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC()) 5209 RuntimeCC = abiCC; 5210 5211 // AAPCS apparently requires runtime support functions to be soft-float, but 5212 // that's almost certainly for historic reasons (Thumb1 not supporting VFP 5213 // most likely). It's more convenient for AAPCS16_VFP to be hard-float. 5214 switch (getABIKind()) { 5215 case APCS: 5216 case AAPCS16_VFP: 5217 if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC()) 5218 BuiltinCC = abiCC; 5219 break; 5220 case AAPCS: 5221 case AAPCS_VFP: 5222 BuiltinCC = llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5223 break; 5224 } 5225 } 5226 5227 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 5228 bool isVariadic) const { 5229 // 6.1.2.1 The following argument types are VFP CPRCs: 5230 // A single-precision floating-point type (including promoted 5231 // half-precision types); A double-precision floating-point type; 5232 // A 64-bit or 128-bit containerized vector type; Homogeneous Aggregate 5233 // with a Base Type of a single- or double-precision floating-point type, 5234 // 64-bit containerized vectors or 128-bit containerized vectors with one 5235 // to four Elements. 5236 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP && !isVariadic; 5237 5238 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 5239 5240 // Handle illegal vector types here. 5241 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 5242 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 5243 if (Size <= 32) { 5244 llvm::Type *ResType = 5245 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5246 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5247 } 5248 if (Size == 64) { 5249 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get( 5250 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2); 5251 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5252 } 5253 if (Size == 128) { 5254 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get( 5255 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4); 5256 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5257 } 5258 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 5259 } 5260 5261 // __fp16 gets passed as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16 bits 5262 // unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type 5263 // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 5264 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 5265 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 5266 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 5267 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5268 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5269 } 5270 5271 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 5272 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5273 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 5274 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5275 } 5276 5277 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 5278 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5279 } 5280 5281 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 5282 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 5283 } 5284 5285 // Ignore empty records. 5286 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 5287 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5288 5289 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 5290 // Homogeneous Aggregates need to be expanded when we can fit the aggregate 5291 // into VFP registers. 5292 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5293 uint64_t Members = 0; 5294 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5295 assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate"); 5296 // Base can be a floating-point or a vector. 5297 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 5298 } 5299 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 5300 // WatchOS does have homogeneous aggregates. Note that we intentionally use 5301 // this convention even for a variadic function: the backend will use GPRs 5302 // if needed. 5303 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5304 uint64_t Members = 0; 5305 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5306 assert(Base && Members <= 4 && "unexpected homogeneous aggregate"); 5307 llvm::Type *Ty = 5308 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members); 5309 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false); 5310 } 5311 } 5312 5313 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 5314 getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)) { 5315 // WatchOS is adopting the 64-bit AAPCS rule on composite types: if they're 5316 // bigger than 128-bits, they get placed in space allocated by the caller, 5317 // and a pointer is passed. 5318 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect( 5319 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8), false); 5320 } 5321 5322 // Support byval for ARM. 5323 // The ABI alignment for APCS is 4-byte and for AAPCS at least 4-byte and at 5324 // most 8-byte. We realign the indirect argument if type alignment is bigger 5325 // than ABI alignment. 5326 uint64_t ABIAlign = 4; 5327 uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 5328 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 5329 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) 5330 ABIAlign = std::min(std::max(TyAlign, (uint64_t)4), (uint64_t)8); 5331 5332 if (getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(64)) { 5333 assert(getABIKind() != ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && "unexpected byval"); 5334 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 5335 /*ByVal=*/true, 5336 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 5337 } 5338 5339 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 64 bytes to an integer array of 5340 // same size and alignment. 5341 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5342 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5343 } 5344 5345 // Otherwise, pass by coercing to a structure of the appropriate size. 5346 llvm::Type* ElemTy; 5347 unsigned SizeRegs; 5348 // FIXME: Try to match the types of the arguments more accurately where 5349 // we can. 5350 if (getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) <= 32) { 5351 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5352 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 5353 } else { 5354 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 5355 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 63) / 64; 5356 } 5357 5358 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(ElemTy, SizeRegs)); 5359 } 5360 5361 static bool isIntegerLikeType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context, 5362 llvm::LLVMContext &VMContext) { 5363 // APCS, C Language Calling Conventions, Non-Simple Return Values: A structure 5364 // is called integer-like if its size is less than or equal to one word, and 5365 // the offset of each of its addressable sub-fields is zero. 5366 5367 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 5368 5369 // Check that the type fits in a word. 5370 if (Size > 32) 5371 return false; 5372 5373 // FIXME: Handle vector types! 5374 if (Ty->isVectorType()) 5375 return false; 5376 5377 // Float types are never treated as "integer like". 5378 if (Ty->isRealFloatingType()) 5379 return false; 5380 5381 // If this is a builtin or pointer type then it is ok. 5382 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->isPointerType()) 5383 return true; 5384 5385 // Small complex integer types are "integer like". 5386 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 5387 return isIntegerLikeType(CT->getElementType(), Context, VMContext); 5388 5389 // Single element and zero sized arrays should be allowed, by the definition 5390 // above, but they are not. 5391 5392 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 5393 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 5394 if (!RT) return false; 5395 5396 // Ignore records with flexible arrays. 5397 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 5398 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 5399 return false; 5400 5401 // Check that all sub-fields are at offset 0, and are themselves "integer 5402 // like". 5403 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 5404 5405 bool HadField = false; 5406 unsigned idx = 0; 5407 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 5408 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 5409 const FieldDecl *FD = *i; 5410 5411 // Bit-fields are not addressable, we only need to verify they are "integer 5412 // like". We still have to disallow a subsequent non-bitfield, for example: 5413 // struct { int : 0; int x } 5414 // is non-integer like according to gcc. 5415 if (FD->isBitField()) { 5416 if (!RD->isUnion()) 5417 HadField = true; 5418 5419 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 5420 return false; 5421 5422 continue; 5423 } 5424 5425 // Check if this field is at offset 0. 5426 if (Layout.getFieldOffset(idx) != 0) 5427 return false; 5428 5429 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 5430 return false; 5431 5432 // Only allow at most one field in a structure. This doesn't match the 5433 // wording above, but follows gcc in situations with a field following an 5434 // empty structure. 5435 if (!RD->isUnion()) { 5436 if (HadField) 5437 return false; 5438 5439 HadField = true; 5440 } 5441 } 5442 5443 return true; 5444 } 5445 5446 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 5447 bool isVariadic) const { 5448 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = 5449 (getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP || getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) && !isVariadic; 5450 5451 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 5452 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5453 5454 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 5455 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) { 5456 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5457 } 5458 5459 // __fp16 gets returned as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16 5460 // bits unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type 5461 // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 5462 if (RetTy->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 5463 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 5464 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 5465 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5466 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5467 } 5468 5469 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 5470 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5471 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 5472 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5473 5474 return RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 5475 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 5476 } 5477 5478 // Are we following APCS? 5479 if (getABIKind() == APCS) { 5480 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, false)) 5481 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5482 5483 // Complex types are all returned as packed integers. 5484 // 5485 // FIXME: Consider using 2 x vector types if the back end handles them 5486 // correctly. 5487 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 5488 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get( 5489 getVMContext(), getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy))); 5490 5491 // Integer like structures are returned in r0. 5492 if (isIntegerLikeType(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext())) { 5493 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 5494 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 5495 if (Size <= 8) 5496 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 5497 if (Size <= 16) 5498 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 5499 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5500 } 5501 5502 // Otherwise return in memory. 5503 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5504 } 5505 5506 // Otherwise this is an AAPCS variant. 5507 5508 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 5509 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5510 5511 // Check for homogeneous aggregates with AAPCS-VFP. 5512 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 5513 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5514 uint64_t Members = 0; 5515 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) { 5516 assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate"); 5517 // Homogeneous Aggregates are returned directly. 5518 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 5519 } 5520 } 5521 5522 // Aggregates <= 4 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 5523 // are returned indirectly. 5524 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 5525 if (Size <= 32) { 5526 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 4 bytes to an integer array of 5527 // same size and alignment. 5528 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5529 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5530 } 5531 if (getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) 5532 // Return in 32 bit integer integer type (as if loaded by LDR, AAPCS 5.4) 5533 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5534 5535 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 5536 if (Size <= 8) 5537 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 5538 if (Size <= 16) 5539 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 5540 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5541 } else if (Size <= 128 && getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) { 5542 llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5543 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = 5544 llvm::ArrayType::get(Int32Ty, llvm::alignTo(Size, 32) / 32); 5545 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 5546 } 5547 5548 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5549 } 5550 5551 /// isIllegalVector - check whether Ty is an illegal vector type. 5552 bool ARMABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 5553 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType> ()) { 5554 if (isAndroid()) { 5555 // Android shipped using Clang 3.1, which supported a slightly different 5556 // vector ABI. The primary differences were that 3-element vector types 5557 // were legal, and so were sub 32-bit vectors (i.e. <2 x i8>). This path 5558 // accepts that legacy behavior for Android only. 5559 // Check whether VT is legal. 5560 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5561 // NumElements should be power of 2 or equal to 3. 5562 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements) && NumElements != 3) 5563 return true; 5564 } else { 5565 // Check whether VT is legal. 5566 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5567 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5568 // NumElements should be power of 2. 5569 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 5570 return true; 5571 // Size should be greater than 32 bits. 5572 return Size <= 32; 5573 } 5574 } 5575 return false; 5576 } 5577 5578 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 5579 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS-VFP must have base types of float, 5580 // double, or 64-bit or 128-bit vectors. 5581 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5582 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 5583 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 5584 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) 5585 return true; 5586 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5587 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5588 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 5589 return true; 5590 } 5591 return false; 5592 } 5593 5594 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 5595 uint64_t Members) const { 5596 return Members <= 4; 5597 } 5598 5599 Address ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5600 QualType Ty) const { 5601 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 5602 5603 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 5604 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 5605 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 5606 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 5607 return Addr; 5608 } 5609 5610 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5611 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 5612 5613 // Use indirect if size of the illegal vector is bigger than 16 bytes. 5614 bool IsIndirect = false; 5615 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5616 uint64_t Members = 0; 5617 if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 5618 IsIndirect = true; 5619 5620 // ARMv7k passes structs bigger than 16 bytes indirectly, in space 5621 // allocated by the caller. 5622 } else if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && 5623 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 5624 !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5625 IsIndirect = true; 5626 5627 // Otherwise, bound the type's ABI alignment. 5628 // The ABI alignment for 64-bit or 128-bit vectors is 8 for AAPCS and 4 for 5629 // APCS. For AAPCS, the ABI alignment is at least 4-byte and at most 8-byte. 5630 // Our callers should be prepared to handle an under-aligned address. 5631 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 5632 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) { 5633 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 5634 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 5635 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 5636 // ARMv7k allows type alignment up to 16 bytes. 5637 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 5638 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 5639 } else { 5640 TyAlignForABI = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 5641 } 5642 TyInfo.second = TyAlignForABI; 5643 5644 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TyInfo, 5645 SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 5646 } 5647 5648 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5649 // NVPTX ABI Implementation 5650 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5651 5652 namespace { 5653 5654 class NVPTXABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 5655 public: 5656 NVPTXABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 5657 5658 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 5659 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 5660 5661 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 5662 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5663 QualType Ty) const override; 5664 }; 5665 5666 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 5667 public: 5668 NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 5669 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new NVPTXABIInfo(CGT)) {} 5670 5671 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5672 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 5673 private: 5674 // Adds a NamedMDNode with F, Name, and Operand as operands, and adds the 5675 // resulting MDNode to the nvvm.annotations MDNode. 5676 static void addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, int Operand); 5677 }; 5678 5679 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 5680 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 5681 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5682 5683 // note: this is different from default ABI 5684 if (!RetTy->isScalarType()) 5685 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 5686 5687 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5688 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 5689 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5690 5691 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 5692 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5693 } 5694 5695 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 5696 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5697 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 5698 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5699 5700 // Return aggregates type as indirect by value 5701 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 5702 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true); 5703 5704 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 5705 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5706 } 5707 5708 void NVPTXABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 5709 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 5710 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 5711 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 5712 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 5713 5714 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 5715 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5716 return; 5717 5718 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(getRuntimeCC()); 5719 } 5720 5721 Address NVPTXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5722 QualType Ty) const { 5723 llvm_unreachable("NVPTX does not support varargs"); 5724 } 5725 5726 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo:: 5727 setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5728 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const{ 5729 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 5730 if (!FD) return; 5731 5732 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 5733 5734 // Perform special handling in OpenCL mode 5735 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 5736 // Use OpenCL function attributes to check for kernel functions 5737 // By default, all functions are device functions 5738 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 5739 // OpenCL __kernel functions get kernel metadata 5740 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 5741 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 5742 // And kernel functions are not subject to inlining 5743 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 5744 } 5745 } 5746 5747 // Perform special handling in CUDA mode. 5748 if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5749 // CUDA __global__ functions get a kernel metadata entry. Since 5750 // __global__ functions cannot be called from the device, we do not 5751 // need to set the noinline attribute. 5752 if (FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) { 5753 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 5754 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 5755 } 5756 if (CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<CUDALaunchBoundsAttr>()) { 5757 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"maxntidx", i32 <val>} node 5758 llvm::APSInt MaxThreads(32); 5759 MaxThreads = Attr->getMaxThreads()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 5760 if (MaxThreads > 0) 5761 addNVVMMetadata(F, "maxntidx", MaxThreads.getExtValue()); 5762 5763 // min blocks is an optional argument for CUDALaunchBoundsAttr. If it was 5764 // not specified in __launch_bounds__ or if the user specified a 0 value, 5765 // we don't have to add a PTX directive. 5766 if (Attr->getMinBlocks()) { 5767 llvm::APSInt MinBlocks(32); 5768 MinBlocks = Attr->getMinBlocks()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 5769 if (MinBlocks > 0) 5770 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"minctasm", i32 <val>} node 5771 addNVVMMetadata(F, "minctasm", MinBlocks.getExtValue()); 5772 } 5773 } 5774 } 5775 } 5776 5777 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, 5778 int Operand) { 5779 llvm::Module *M = F->getParent(); 5780 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = M->getContext(); 5781 5782 // Get "nvvm.annotations" metadata node 5783 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = M->getOrInsertNamedMetadata("nvvm.annotations"); 5784 5785 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = { 5786 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F), llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Name), 5787 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get( 5788 llvm::ConstantInt::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx), Operand))}; 5789 // Append metadata to nvvm.annotations 5790 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 5791 } 5792 } 5793 5794 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5795 // SystemZ ABI Implementation 5796 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5797 5798 namespace { 5799 5800 class SystemZABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 5801 bool HasVector; 5802 5803 public: 5804 SystemZABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HV) 5805 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), HasVector(HV) {} 5806 5807 bool isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const; 5808 bool isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const; 5809 bool isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 5810 bool isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 5811 QualType GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const; 5812 5813 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 5814 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType ArgTy) const; 5815 5816 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 5817 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 5818 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 5819 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 5820 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 5821 } 5822 5823 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5824 QualType Ty) const override; 5825 5826 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 5827 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 5828 bool asReturnValue) const override { 5829 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 5830 } 5831 }; 5832 5833 class SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 5834 public: 5835 SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HasVector) 5836 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SystemZABIInfo(CGT, HasVector)) {} 5837 }; 5838 5839 } 5840 5841 bool SystemZABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const { 5842 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5843 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 5844 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5845 5846 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 5847 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 5848 return true; 5849 5850 // 32-bit values must also be promoted. 5851 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 5852 switch (BT->getKind()) { 5853 case BuiltinType::Int: 5854 case BuiltinType::UInt: 5855 return true; 5856 default: 5857 return false; 5858 } 5859 return false; 5860 } 5861 5862 bool SystemZABIInfo::isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const { 5863 return (Ty->isAnyComplexType() || 5864 Ty->isVectorType() || 5865 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)); 5866 } 5867 5868 bool SystemZABIInfo::isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 5869 return (HasVector && 5870 Ty->isVectorType() && 5871 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128); 5872 } 5873 5874 bool SystemZABIInfo::isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 5875 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 5876 switch (BT->getKind()) { 5877 case BuiltinType::Float: 5878 case BuiltinType::Double: 5879 return true; 5880 default: 5881 return false; 5882 } 5883 5884 return false; 5885 } 5886 5887 QualType SystemZABIInfo::GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const { 5888 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAsStructureType()) { 5889 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 5890 QualType Found; 5891 5892 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 5893 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 5894 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 5895 QualType Base = I.getType(); 5896 5897 // Empty bases don't affect things either way. 5898 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base, true)) 5899 continue; 5900 5901 if (!Found.isNull()) 5902 return Ty; 5903 Found = GetSingleElementType(Base); 5904 } 5905 5906 // Check the fields. 5907 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 5908 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 5909 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), empty structure and array fields 5910 // do count. So do anonymous bitfields that aren't zero-sized. 5911 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5912 FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0) 5913 continue; 5914 5915 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), arrays do not count. 5916 // Nested structures still do though. 5917 if (!Found.isNull()) 5918 return Ty; 5919 Found = GetSingleElementType(FD->getType()); 5920 } 5921 5922 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), trailing padding is allowed. 5923 // An 8-byte aligned struct s { float f; } is passed as a double. 5924 if (!Found.isNull()) 5925 return Found; 5926 } 5927 5928 return Ty; 5929 } 5930 5931 Address SystemZABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5932 QualType Ty) const { 5933 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 5934 // struct { 5935 // i64 __gpr; 5936 // i64 __fpr; 5937 // i8 *__overflow_arg_area; 5938 // i8 *__reg_save_area; 5939 // }; 5940 5941 // Every non-vector argument occupies 8 bytes and is passed by preference 5942 // in either GPRs or FPRs. Vector arguments occupy 8 or 16 bytes and are 5943 // always passed on the stack. 5944 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 5945 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5946 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 5947 llvm::Type *DirectTy = ArgTy; 5948 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 5949 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 5950 bool InFPRs = false; 5951 bool IsVector = false; 5952 CharUnits UnpaddedSize; 5953 CharUnits DirectAlign; 5954 if (IsIndirect) { 5955 DirectTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(DirectTy); 5956 UnpaddedSize = DirectAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5957 } else { 5958 if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 5959 ArgTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 5960 InFPRs = ArgTy->isFloatTy() || ArgTy->isDoubleTy(); 5961 IsVector = ArgTy->isVectorTy(); 5962 UnpaddedSize = TyInfo.first; 5963 DirectAlign = TyInfo.second; 5964 } 5965 CharUnits PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5966 if (IsVector && UnpaddedSize > PaddedSize) 5967 PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 5968 assert((UnpaddedSize <= PaddedSize) && "Invalid argument size."); 5969 5970 CharUnits Padding = (PaddedSize - UnpaddedSize); 5971 5972 llvm::Type *IndexTy = CGF.Int64Ty; 5973 llvm::Value *PaddedSizeV = 5974 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, PaddedSize.getQuantity()); 5975 5976 if (IsVector) { 5977 // Work out the address of a vector argument on the stack. 5978 // Vector arguments are always passed in the high bits of a 5979 // single (8 byte) or double (16 byte) stack slot. 5980 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = 5981 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16), 5982 "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 5983 Address OverflowArgArea = 5984 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 5985 TyInfo.second); 5986 Address MemAddr = 5987 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArgArea, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 5988 5989 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 5990 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 5991 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 5992 "overflow_arg_area"); 5993 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 5994 5995 return MemAddr; 5996 } 5997 5998 assert(PaddedSize.getQuantity() == 8); 5999 6000 unsigned MaxRegs, RegCountField, RegSaveIndex; 6001 CharUnits RegPadding; 6002 if (InFPRs) { 6003 MaxRegs = 4; // Maximum of 4 FPR arguments 6004 RegCountField = 1; // __fpr 6005 RegSaveIndex = 16; // save offset for f0 6006 RegPadding = CharUnits(); // floats are passed in the high bits of an FPR 6007 } else { 6008 MaxRegs = 5; // Maximum of 5 GPR arguments 6009 RegCountField = 0; // __gpr 6010 RegSaveIndex = 2; // save offset for r2 6011 RegPadding = Padding; // values are passed in the low bits of a GPR 6012 } 6013 6014 Address RegCountPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 6015 VAListAddr, RegCountField, RegCountField * CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 6016 "reg_count_ptr"); 6017 llvm::Value *RegCount = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegCountPtr, "reg_count"); 6018 llvm::Value *MaxRegsV = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, MaxRegs); 6019 llvm::Value *InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULT(RegCount, MaxRegsV, 6020 "fits_in_regs"); 6021 6022 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 6023 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 6024 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 6025 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 6026 6027 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 6028 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 6029 6030 // Work out the address of an argument register. 6031 llvm::Value *ScaledRegCount = 6032 CGF.Builder.CreateMul(RegCount, PaddedSizeV, "scaled_reg_count"); 6033 llvm::Value *RegBase = 6034 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, RegSaveIndex * PaddedSize.getQuantity() 6035 + RegPadding.getQuantity()); 6036 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 6037 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(ScaledRegCount, RegBase, "reg_offset"); 6038 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = 6039 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24), 6040 "reg_save_area_ptr"); 6041 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = 6042 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr, "reg_save_area"); 6043 Address RawRegAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, RegOffset, 6044 "raw_reg_addr"), 6045 PaddedSize); 6046 Address RegAddr = 6047 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawRegAddr, DirectTy, "reg_addr"); 6048 6049 // Update the register count 6050 llvm::Value *One = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, 1); 6051 llvm::Value *NewRegCount = 6052 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(RegCount, One, "reg_count"); 6053 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewRegCount, RegCountPtr); 6054 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6055 6056 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 6057 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 6058 6059 // Work out the address of a stack argument. 6060 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 6061 VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16), "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 6062 Address OverflowArgArea = 6063 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 6064 PaddedSize); 6065 Address RawMemAddr = 6066 CGF.Builder.CreateConstByteGEP(OverflowArgArea, Padding, "raw_mem_addr"); 6067 Address MemAddr = 6068 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawMemAddr, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 6069 6070 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 6071 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 6072 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 6073 "overflow_arg_area"); 6074 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 6075 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6076 6077 // Return the appropriate result. 6078 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 6079 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 6080 MemAddr, InMemBlock, "va_arg.addr"); 6081 6082 if (IsIndirect) 6083 ResAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "indirect_arg"), 6084 TyInfo.second); 6085 6086 return ResAddr; 6087 } 6088 6089 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6090 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6091 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6092 if (isVectorArgumentType(RetTy)) 6093 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6094 if (isCompoundType(RetTy) || getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 6095 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6096 return (isPromotableIntegerType(RetTy) ? 6097 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6098 } 6099 6100 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6101 // Handle the generic C++ ABI. 6102 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 6103 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6104 6105 // Integers and enums are extended to full register width. 6106 if (isPromotableIntegerType(Ty)) 6107 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 6108 6109 // Handle vector types and vector-like structure types. Note that 6110 // as opposed to float-like structure types, we do not allow any 6111 // padding for vector-like structures, so verify the sizes match. 6112 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6113 QualType SingleElementTy = GetSingleElementType(Ty); 6114 if (isVectorArgumentType(SingleElementTy) && 6115 getContext().getTypeSize(SingleElementTy) == Size) 6116 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(SingleElementTy)); 6117 6118 // Values that are not 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes in size are passed indirectly. 6119 if (Size != 8 && Size != 16 && Size != 32 && Size != 64) 6120 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6121 6122 // Handle small structures. 6123 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 6124 // Structures with flexible arrays have variable length, so really 6125 // fail the size test above. 6126 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6127 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 6128 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6129 6130 // The structure is passed as an unextended integer, a float, or a double. 6131 llvm::Type *PassTy; 6132 if (isFPArgumentType(SingleElementTy)) { 6133 assert(Size == 32 || Size == 64); 6134 if (Size == 32) 6135 PassTy = llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 6136 else 6137 PassTy = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 6138 } else 6139 PassTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 6140 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(PassTy); 6141 } 6142 6143 // Non-structure compounds are passed indirectly. 6144 if (isCompoundType(Ty)) 6145 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6146 6147 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr); 6148 } 6149 6150 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6151 // MSP430 ABI Implementation 6152 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6153 6154 namespace { 6155 6156 class MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6157 public: 6158 MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6159 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6160 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6161 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6162 }; 6163 6164 } 6165 6166 void MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 6167 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6168 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6169 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 6170 if (const MSP430InterruptAttr *attr = FD->getAttr<MSP430InterruptAttr>()) { 6171 // Handle 'interrupt' attribute: 6172 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6173 6174 // Step 1: Set ISR calling convention. 6175 F->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::MSP430_INTR); 6176 6177 // Step 2: Add attributes goodness. 6178 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6179 6180 // Step 3: Emit ISR vector alias. 6181 unsigned Num = attr->getNumber() / 2; 6182 llvm::GlobalAlias::create(llvm::Function::ExternalLinkage, 6183 "__isr_" + Twine(Num), F); 6184 } 6185 } 6186 } 6187 6188 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6189 // MIPS ABI Implementation. This works for both little-endian and 6190 // big-endian variants. 6191 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6192 6193 namespace { 6194 class MipsABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6195 bool IsO32; 6196 unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes, StackAlignInBytes; 6197 void CoerceToIntArgs(uint64_t TySize, 6198 SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const; 6199 llvm::Type* HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const; 6200 llvm::Type* returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const; 6201 llvm::Type* getPaddingType(uint64_t Align, uint64_t Offset) const; 6202 public: 6203 MipsABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool _IsO32) : 6204 ABIInfo(CGT), IsO32(_IsO32), MinABIStackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 4 : 8), 6205 StackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 8 : 16) {} 6206 6207 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6208 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, uint64_t &Offset) const; 6209 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6210 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6211 QualType Ty) const override; 6212 bool shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const override; 6213 }; 6214 6215 class MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6216 unsigned SizeOfUnwindException; 6217 public: 6218 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool IsO32) 6219 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new MipsABIInfo(CGT, IsO32)), 6220 SizeOfUnwindException(IsO32 ? 24 : 32) {} 6221 6222 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6223 return 29; 6224 } 6225 6226 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6227 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6228 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6229 if (!FD) return; 6230 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6231 if (FD->hasAttr<Mips16Attr>()) { 6232 Fn->addFnAttr("mips16"); 6233 } 6234 else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMips16Attr>()) { 6235 Fn->addFnAttr("nomips16"); 6236 } 6237 6238 const MipsInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<MipsInterruptAttr>(); 6239 if (!Attr) 6240 return; 6241 6242 const char *Kind; 6243 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 6244 case MipsInterruptAttr::eic: Kind = "eic"; break; 6245 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw0: Kind = "sw0"; break; 6246 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw1: Kind = "sw1"; break; 6247 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw0: Kind = "hw0"; break; 6248 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw1: Kind = "hw1"; break; 6249 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw2: Kind = "hw2"; break; 6250 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw3: Kind = "hw3"; break; 6251 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw4: Kind = "hw4"; break; 6252 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw5: Kind = "hw5"; break; 6253 } 6254 6255 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 6256 6257 } 6258 6259 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 6260 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 6261 6262 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 6263 return SizeOfUnwindException; 6264 } 6265 }; 6266 } 6267 6268 void MipsABIInfo::CoerceToIntArgs( 6269 uint64_t TySize, SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const { 6270 llvm::IntegerType *IntTy = 6271 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6272 6273 // Add (TySize / MinABIStackAlignInBytes) args of IntTy. 6274 for (unsigned N = TySize / (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); N; --N) 6275 ArgList.push_back(IntTy); 6276 6277 // If necessary, add one more integer type to ArgList. 6278 unsigned R = TySize % (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6279 6280 if (R) 6281 ArgList.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), R)); 6282 } 6283 6284 // In N32/64, an aligned double precision floating point field is passed in 6285 // a register. 6286 llvm::Type* MipsABIInfo::HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const { 6287 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> ArgList, IntArgList; 6288 6289 if (IsO32) { 6290 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6291 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6292 } 6293 6294 if (Ty->isComplexType()) 6295 return CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 6296 6297 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6298 6299 // Unions/vectors are passed in integer registers. 6300 if (!RT || !RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 6301 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6302 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6303 } 6304 6305 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6306 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6307 assert(!(TySize % 8) && "Size of structure must be multiple of 8."); 6308 6309 uint64_t LastOffset = 0; 6310 unsigned idx = 0; 6311 llvm::IntegerType *I64 = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64); 6312 6313 // Iterate over fields in the struct/class and check if there are any aligned 6314 // double fields. 6315 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 6316 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 6317 const QualType Ty = i->getType(); 6318 const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 6319 6320 if (!BT || BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Double) 6321 continue; 6322 6323 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 6324 if (Offset % 64) // Ignore doubles that are not aligned. 6325 continue; 6326 6327 // Add ((Offset - LastOffset) / 64) args of type i64. 6328 for (unsigned j = (Offset - LastOffset) / 64; j > 0; --j) 6329 ArgList.push_back(I64); 6330 6331 // Add double type. 6332 ArgList.push_back(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext())); 6333 LastOffset = Offset + 64; 6334 } 6335 6336 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize - LastOffset, IntArgList); 6337 ArgList.append(IntArgList.begin(), IntArgList.end()); 6338 6339 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6340 } 6341 6342 llvm::Type *MipsABIInfo::getPaddingType(uint64_t OrigOffset, 6343 uint64_t Offset) const { 6344 if (OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes > Offset) 6345 return nullptr; 6346 6347 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), (Offset - OrigOffset) * 8); 6348 } 6349 6350 ABIArgInfo 6351 MipsABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint64_t &Offset) const { 6352 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 6353 6354 uint64_t OrigOffset = Offset; 6355 uint64_t TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6356 uint64_t Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 6357 6358 Align = std::min(std::max(Align, (uint64_t)MinABIStackAlignInBytes), 6359 (uint64_t)StackAlignInBytes); 6360 unsigned CurrOffset = llvm::alignTo(Offset, Align); 6361 Offset = CurrOffset + llvm::alignTo(TySize, Align * 8) / 8; 6362 6363 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isVectorType()) { 6364 // Ignore empty aggregates. 6365 if (TySize == 0) 6366 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6367 6368 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 6369 Offset = OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 6370 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6371 } 6372 6373 // If we have reached here, aggregates are passed directly by coercing to 6374 // another structure type. Padding is inserted if the offset of the 6375 // aggregate is unaligned. 6376 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 6377 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HandleAggregates(Ty, TySize), 0, 6378 getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 6379 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 6380 return ArgInfo; 6381 } 6382 6383 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6384 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6385 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6386 6387 // All integral types are promoted to the GPR width. 6388 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 6389 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 6390 6391 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 6392 nullptr, 0, IsO32 ? nullptr : getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 6393 } 6394 6395 llvm::Type* 6396 MipsABIInfo::returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const { 6397 const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>(); 6398 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> RTList; 6399 6400 if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 6401 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6402 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6403 unsigned FieldCnt = Layout.getFieldCount(); 6404 6405 // N32/64 returns struct/classes in floating point registers if the 6406 // following conditions are met: 6407 // 1. The size of the struct/class is no larger than 128-bit. 6408 // 2. The struct/class has one or two fields all of which are floating 6409 // point types. 6410 // 3. The offset of the first field is zero (this follows what gcc does). 6411 // 6412 // Any other composite results are returned in integer registers. 6413 // 6414 if (FieldCnt && (FieldCnt <= 2) && !Layout.getFieldOffset(0)) { 6415 RecordDecl::field_iterator b = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 6416 for (; b != e; ++b) { 6417 const BuiltinType *BT = b->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 6418 6419 if (!BT || !BT->isFloatingPoint()) 6420 break; 6421 6422 RTList.push_back(CGT.ConvertType(b->getType())); 6423 } 6424 6425 if (b == e) 6426 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList, 6427 RD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>()); 6428 6429 RTList.clear(); 6430 } 6431 } 6432 6433 CoerceToIntArgs(Size, RTList); 6434 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList); 6435 } 6436 6437 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6438 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 6439 6440 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6441 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6442 6443 // O32 doesn't treat zero-sized structs differently from other structs. 6444 // However, N32/N64 ignores zero sized return values. 6445 if (!IsO32 && Size == 0) 6446 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6447 6448 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) || RetTy->isVectorType()) { 6449 if (Size <= 128) { 6450 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 6451 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6452 6453 // O32 returns integer vectors in registers and N32/N64 returns all small 6454 // aggregates in registers. 6455 if (!IsO32 || 6456 (RetTy->isVectorType() && !RetTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())) { 6457 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 6458 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(returnAggregateInRegs(RetTy, Size)); 6459 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 6460 return ArgInfo; 6461 } 6462 } 6463 6464 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6465 } 6466 6467 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6468 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6469 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6470 6471 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6472 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6473 } 6474 6475 void MipsABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6476 ABIArgInfo &RetInfo = FI.getReturnInfo(); 6477 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6478 RetInfo = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6479 6480 // Check if a pointer to an aggregate is passed as a hidden argument. 6481 uint64_t Offset = RetInfo.isIndirect() ? MinABIStackAlignInBytes : 0; 6482 6483 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6484 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, Offset); 6485 } 6486 6487 Address MipsABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6488 QualType OrigTy) const { 6489 QualType Ty = OrigTy; 6490 6491 // Integer arguments are promoted to 32-bit on O32 and 64-bit on N32/N64. 6492 // Pointers are also promoted in the same way but this only matters for N32. 6493 unsigned SlotSizeInBits = IsO32 ? 32 : 64; 6494 unsigned PtrWidth = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 6495 bool DidPromote = false; 6496 if ((Ty->isIntegerType() && 6497 getContext().getIntWidth(Ty) < SlotSizeInBits) || 6498 (Ty->isPointerType() && PtrWidth < SlotSizeInBits)) { 6499 DidPromote = true; 6500 Ty = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(SlotSizeInBits, 6501 Ty->isSignedIntegerType()); 6502 } 6503 6504 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 6505 6506 // The alignment of things in the argument area is never larger than 6507 // StackAlignInBytes. 6508 TyInfo.second = 6509 std::min(TyInfo.second, CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlignInBytes)); 6510 6511 // MinABIStackAlignInBytes is the size of argument slots on the stack. 6512 CharUnits ArgSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 6513 6514 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 6515 TyInfo, ArgSlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 6516 6517 6518 // If there was a promotion, "unpromote" into a temporary. 6519 // TODO: can we just use a pointer into a subset of the original slot? 6520 if (DidPromote) { 6521 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(OrigTy, "vaarg.promotion-temp"); 6522 llvm::Value *Promoted = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr); 6523 6524 // Truncate down to the right width. 6525 llvm::Type *IntTy = (OrigTy->isIntegerType() ? Temp.getElementType() 6526 : CGF.IntPtrTy); 6527 llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateTrunc(Promoted, IntTy); 6528 if (OrigTy->isPointerType()) 6529 V = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(V, Temp.getElementType()); 6530 6531 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, Temp); 6532 Addr = Temp; 6533 } 6534 6535 return Addr; 6536 } 6537 6538 bool MipsABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const { 6539 int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6540 6541 // MIPS64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended. 6542 if (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32) 6543 return true; 6544 6545 return false; 6546 } 6547 6548 bool 6549 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 6550 llvm::Value *Address) const { 6551 // This information comes from gcc's implementation, which seems to 6552 // as canonical as it gets. 6553 6554 // Everything on MIPS is 4 bytes. Double-precision FP registers 6555 // are aliased to pairs of single-precision FP registers. 6556 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 6557 6558 // 0-31 are the general purpose registers, $0 - $31. 6559 // 32-63 are the floating-point registers, $f0 - $f31. 6560 // 64 and 65 are the multiply/divide registers, $hi and $lo. 6561 // 66 is the (notional, I think) register for signal-handler return. 6562 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 65); 6563 6564 // 67-74 are the floating-point status registers, $fcc0 - $fcc7. 6565 // They are one bit wide and ignored here. 6566 6567 // 80-111 are the coprocessor 0 registers, $c0r0 - $c0r31. 6568 // (coprocessor 1 is the FP unit) 6569 // 112-143 are the coprocessor 2 registers, $c2r0 - $c2r31. 6570 // 144-175 are the coprocessor 3 registers, $c3r0 - $c3r31. 6571 // 176-181 are the DSP accumulator registers. 6572 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 80, 181); 6573 return false; 6574 } 6575 6576 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6577 // TCE ABI Implementation (see http://tce.cs.tut.fi). Uses mostly the defaults. 6578 // Currently subclassed only to implement custom OpenCL C function attribute 6579 // handling. 6580 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6581 6582 namespace { 6583 6584 class TCETargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 6585 public: 6586 TCETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6587 : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 6588 6589 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6590 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6591 }; 6592 6593 void TCETargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 6594 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6595 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6596 if (!FD) return; 6597 6598 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6599 6600 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6601 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 6602 // OpenCL C Kernel functions are not subject to inlining 6603 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6604 const ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>(); 6605 if (Attr) { 6606 // Convert the reqd_work_group_size() attributes to metadata. 6607 llvm::LLVMContext &Context = F->getContext(); 6608 llvm::NamedMDNode *OpenCLMetadata = 6609 M.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata( 6610 "opencl.kernel_wg_size_info"); 6611 6612 SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 5> Operands; 6613 Operands.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F)); 6614 6615 Operands.push_back( 6616 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 6617 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getXDim())))); 6618 Operands.push_back( 6619 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 6620 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getYDim())))); 6621 Operands.push_back( 6622 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 6623 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getZDim())))); 6624 6625 // Add a boolean constant operand for "required" (true) or "hint" 6626 // (false) for implementing the work_group_size_hint attr later. 6627 // Currently always true as the hint is not yet implemented. 6628 Operands.push_back( 6629 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::getTrue(Context))); 6630 OpenCLMetadata->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Context, Operands)); 6631 } 6632 } 6633 } 6634 } 6635 6636 } 6637 6638 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6639 // Hexagon ABI Implementation 6640 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6641 6642 namespace { 6643 6644 class HexagonABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6645 6646 6647 public: 6648 HexagonABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 6649 6650 private: 6651 6652 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6653 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 6654 6655 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6656 6657 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6658 QualType Ty) const override; 6659 }; 6660 6661 class HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6662 public: 6663 HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6664 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new HexagonABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6665 6666 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 6667 return 29; 6668 } 6669 }; 6670 6671 } 6672 6673 void HexagonABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6674 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6675 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6676 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6677 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 6678 } 6679 6680 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6681 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 6682 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6683 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6684 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6685 6686 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6687 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6688 } 6689 6690 // Ignore empty records. 6691 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 6692 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6693 6694 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 6695 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6696 6697 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6698 if (Size > 64) 6699 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true); 6700 // Pass in the smallest viable integer type. 6701 else if (Size > 32) 6702 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 6703 else if (Size > 16) 6704 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 6705 else if (Size > 8) 6706 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 6707 else 6708 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 6709 } 6710 6711 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6712 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6713 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6714 6715 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 6716 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 6717 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6718 6719 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 6720 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6721 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6722 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6723 6724 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6725 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6726 } 6727 6728 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 6729 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6730 6731 // Aggregates <= 8 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 6732 // are returned indirectly. 6733 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 6734 if (Size <= 64) { 6735 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 6736 if (Size <= 8) 6737 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 6738 if (Size <= 16) 6739 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 6740 if (Size <= 32) 6741 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 6742 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 6743 } 6744 6745 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/true); 6746 } 6747 6748 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6749 QualType Ty) const { 6750 // FIXME: Someone needs to audit that this handle alignment correctly. 6751 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 6752 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 6753 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 6754 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 6755 } 6756 6757 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6758 // Lanai ABI Implementation 6759 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6760 6761 namespace { 6762 class LanaiABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 6763 public: 6764 LanaiABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 6765 6766 bool shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 6767 6768 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 6769 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 6770 // Lanai uses 4 registers to pass arguments unless the function has the 6771 // regparm attribute set. 6772 if (FI.getHasRegParm()) { 6773 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 6774 } else { 6775 State.FreeRegs = 4; 6776 } 6777 6778 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6779 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6780 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6781 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 6782 } 6783 6784 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 6785 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 6786 }; 6787 } // end anonymous namespace 6788 6789 bool LanaiABIInfo::shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 6790 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6791 unsigned SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(Size, 32U) / 32U; 6792 6793 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 6794 return false; 6795 6796 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 6797 State.FreeRegs = 0; 6798 return false; 6799 } 6800 6801 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 6802 6803 return true; 6804 } 6805 6806 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 6807 CCState &State) const { 6808 if (!ByVal) { 6809 if (State.FreeRegs) { 6810 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 6811 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 6812 } 6813 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 6814 } 6815 6816 // Compute the byval alignment. 6817 const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 6818 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 6819 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true, 6820 /*Realign=*/TypeAlign > 6821 MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 6822 } 6823 6824 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 6825 CCState &State) const { 6826 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 6827 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6828 if (RT) { 6829 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 6830 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 6831 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 6832 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 6833 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByRef=*/true); 6834 } 6835 } 6836 6837 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 6838 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 6839 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 6840 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State); 6841 6842 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 6843 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 6844 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6845 6846 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 6847 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 6848 if (SizeInRegs <= State.FreeRegs) { 6849 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 6850 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 6851 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 6852 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 6853 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 6854 } else { 6855 State.FreeRegs = 0; 6856 } 6857 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 6858 } 6859 6860 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6861 if (const auto *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6862 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6863 6864 bool InReg = shouldUseInReg(Ty, State); 6865 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 6866 if (InReg) 6867 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 6868 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 6869 } 6870 if (InReg) 6871 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 6872 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6873 } 6874 6875 namespace { 6876 class LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6877 public: 6878 LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6879 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new LanaiABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6880 }; 6881 } 6882 6883 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6884 // AMDGPU ABI Implementation 6885 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6886 6887 namespace { 6888 6889 class AMDGPUABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo { 6890 public: 6891 explicit AMDGPUABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 6892 6893 private: 6894 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6895 6896 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6897 }; 6898 6899 void AMDGPUABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6900 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6901 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6902 6903 unsigned CC = FI.getCallingConvention(); 6904 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 6905 if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL) 6906 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 6907 else 6908 Arg.info = DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 6909 } 6910 6911 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 6912 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6913 llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)); 6914 if (!StrTy) { 6915 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 6916 } 6917 6918 // Coerce single element structs to its element. 6919 if (StrTy->getNumElements() == 1) { 6920 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6921 } 6922 6923 // If we set CanBeFlattened to true, CodeGen will expand the struct to its 6924 // individual elements, which confuses the Clover OpenCL backend; therefore we 6925 // have to set it to false here. Other args of getDirect() are just defaults. 6926 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 6927 } 6928 6929 class AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6930 public: 6931 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6932 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AMDGPUABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6933 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6934 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6935 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 6936 }; 6937 6938 } 6939 6940 static void appendOpenCLVersionMD (CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM); 6941 6942 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 6943 const Decl *D, 6944 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6945 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6946 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6947 if (!FD) 6948 return; 6949 6950 if (const auto Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumVGPRAttr>()) { 6951 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6952 uint32_t NumVGPR = Attr->getNumVGPR(); 6953 if (NumVGPR != 0) 6954 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu_num_vgpr", llvm::utostr(NumVGPR)); 6955 } 6956 6957 if (const auto Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumSGPRAttr>()) { 6958 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6959 unsigned NumSGPR = Attr->getNumSGPR(); 6960 if (NumSGPR != 0) 6961 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu_num_sgpr", llvm::utostr(NumSGPR)); 6962 } 6963 6964 appendOpenCLVersionMD(M); 6965 } 6966 6967 6968 unsigned AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 6969 return llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL; 6970 } 6971 6972 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6973 // SPARC v8 ABI Implementation. 6974 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 6975 // 6976 // Ensures that complex values are passed in registers. 6977 // 6978 namespace { 6979 class SparcV8ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 6980 public: 6981 SparcV8ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 6982 6983 private: 6984 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6985 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6986 }; 6987 } // end anonymous namespace 6988 6989 6990 ABIArgInfo 6991 SparcV8ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const { 6992 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) { 6993 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6994 } 6995 else { 6996 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty); 6997 } 6998 } 6999 7000 void SparcV8ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7001 7002 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7003 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 7004 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 7005 } 7006 7007 namespace { 7008 class SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7009 public: 7010 SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7011 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV8ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7012 }; 7013 } // end anonymous namespace 7014 7015 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7016 // SPARC v9 ABI Implementation. 7017 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 7018 // 7019 // Function arguments a mapped to a nominal "parameter array" and promoted to 7020 // registers depending on their type. Each argument occupies 8 or 16 bytes in 7021 // the array, structs larger than 16 bytes are passed indirectly. 7022 // 7023 // One case requires special care: 7024 // 7025 // struct mixed { 7026 // int i; 7027 // float f; 7028 // }; 7029 // 7030 // When a struct mixed is passed by value, it only occupies 8 bytes in the 7031 // parameter array, but the int is passed in an integer register, and the float 7032 // is passed in a floating point register. This is represented as two arguments 7033 // with the LLVM IR inreg attribute: 7034 // 7035 // declare void f(i32 inreg %i, float inreg %f) 7036 // 7037 // The code generator will only allocate 4 bytes from the parameter array for 7038 // the inreg arguments. All other arguments are allocated a multiple of 8 7039 // bytes. 7040 // 7041 namespace { 7042 class SparcV9ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 7043 public: 7044 SparcV9ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 7045 7046 private: 7047 ABIArgInfo classifyType(QualType RetTy, unsigned SizeLimit) const; 7048 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7049 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7050 QualType Ty) const override; 7051 7052 // Coercion type builder for structs passed in registers. The coercion type 7053 // serves two purposes: 7054 // 7055 // 1. Pad structs to a multiple of 64 bits, so they are passed 'left-aligned' 7056 // in registers. 7057 // 2. Expose aligned floating point elements as first-level elements, so the 7058 // code generator knows to pass them in floating point registers. 7059 // 7060 // We also compute the InReg flag which indicates that the struct contains 7061 // aligned 32-bit floats. 7062 // 7063 struct CoerceBuilder { 7064 llvm::LLVMContext &Context; 7065 const llvm::DataLayout &DL; 7066 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> Elems; 7067 uint64_t Size; 7068 bool InReg; 7069 7070 CoerceBuilder(llvm::LLVMContext &c, const llvm::DataLayout &dl) 7071 : Context(c), DL(dl), Size(0), InReg(false) {} 7072 7073 // Pad Elems with integers until Size is ToSize. 7074 void pad(uint64_t ToSize) { 7075 assert(ToSize >= Size && "Cannot remove elements"); 7076 if (ToSize == Size) 7077 return; 7078 7079 // Finish the current 64-bit word. 7080 uint64_t Aligned = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); 7081 if (Aligned > Size && Aligned <= ToSize) { 7082 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, Aligned - Size)); 7083 Size = Aligned; 7084 } 7085 7086 // Add whole 64-bit words. 7087 while (Size + 64 <= ToSize) { 7088 Elems.push_back(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Context)); 7089 Size += 64; 7090 } 7091 7092 // Final in-word padding. 7093 if (Size < ToSize) { 7094 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, ToSize - Size)); 7095 Size = ToSize; 7096 } 7097 } 7098 7099 // Add a floating point element at Offset. 7100 void addFloat(uint64_t Offset, llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned Bits) { 7101 // Unaligned floats are treated as integers. 7102 if (Offset % Bits) 7103 return; 7104 // The InReg flag is only required if there are any floats < 64 bits. 7105 if (Bits < 64) 7106 InReg = true; 7107 pad(Offset); 7108 Elems.push_back(Ty); 7109 Size = Offset + Bits; 7110 } 7111 7112 // Add a struct type to the coercion type, starting at Offset (in bits). 7113 void addStruct(uint64_t Offset, llvm::StructType *StrTy) { 7114 const llvm::StructLayout *Layout = DL.getStructLayout(StrTy); 7115 for (unsigned i = 0, e = StrTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) { 7116 llvm::Type *ElemTy = StrTy->getElementType(i); 7117 uint64_t ElemOffset = Offset + Layout->getElementOffsetInBits(i); 7118 switch (ElemTy->getTypeID()) { 7119 case llvm::Type::StructTyID: 7120 addStruct(ElemOffset, cast<llvm::StructType>(ElemTy)); 7121 break; 7122 case llvm::Type::FloatTyID: 7123 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 32); 7124 break; 7125 case llvm::Type::DoubleTyID: 7126 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 64); 7127 break; 7128 case llvm::Type::FP128TyID: 7129 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 128); 7130 break; 7131 case llvm::Type::PointerTyID: 7132 if (ElemOffset % 64 == 0) { 7133 pad(ElemOffset); 7134 Elems.push_back(ElemTy); 7135 Size += 64; 7136 } 7137 break; 7138 default: 7139 break; 7140 } 7141 } 7142 } 7143 7144 // Check if Ty is a usable substitute for the coercion type. 7145 bool isUsableType(llvm::StructType *Ty) const { 7146 return llvm::makeArrayRef(Elems) == Ty->elements(); 7147 } 7148 7149 // Get the coercion type as a literal struct type. 7150 llvm::Type *getType() const { 7151 if (Elems.size() == 1) 7152 return Elems.front(); 7153 else 7154 return llvm::StructType::get(Context, Elems); 7155 } 7156 }; 7157 }; 7158 } // end anonymous namespace 7159 7160 ABIArgInfo 7161 SparcV9ABIInfo::classifyType(QualType Ty, unsigned SizeLimit) const { 7162 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 7163 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7164 7165 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7166 7167 // Anything too big to fit in registers is passed with an explicit indirect 7168 // pointer / sret pointer. 7169 if (Size > SizeLimit) 7170 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 7171 7172 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7173 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7174 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7175 7176 // Integer types smaller than a register are extended. 7177 if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType()) 7178 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 7179 7180 // Other non-aggregates go in registers. 7181 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 7182 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7183 7184 // If a C++ object has either a non-trivial copy constructor or a non-trivial 7185 // destructor, it is passed with an explicit indirect pointer / sret pointer. 7186 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 7187 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7188 7189 // This is a small aggregate type that should be passed in registers. 7190 // Build a coercion type from the LLVM struct type. 7191 llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)); 7192 if (!StrTy) 7193 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7194 7195 CoerceBuilder CB(getVMContext(), getDataLayout()); 7196 CB.addStruct(0, StrTy); 7197 CB.pad(llvm::alignTo(CB.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StrTy), 64)); 7198 7199 // Try to use the original type for coercion. 7200 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = CB.isUsableType(StrTy) ? StrTy : CB.getType(); 7201 7202 if (CB.InReg) 7203 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CoerceTy); 7204 else 7205 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 7206 } 7207 7208 Address SparcV9ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7209 QualType Ty) const { 7210 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyType(Ty, 16 * 8); 7211 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 7212 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 7213 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 7214 7215 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 7216 7217 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7218 Address Addr(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 7219 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 7220 7221 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 7222 7223 Address ArgAddr = Address::invalid(); 7224 CharUnits Stride; 7225 switch (AI.getKind()) { 7226 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 7227 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 7228 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 7229 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 7230 7231 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: { 7232 Stride = SlotSize; 7233 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TypeInfo.first; 7234 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Offset, "extend"); 7235 break; 7236 } 7237 7238 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: { 7239 auto AllocSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType()); 7240 Stride = CharUnits::fromQuantity(AllocSize).alignTo(SlotSize); 7241 ArgAddr = Addr; 7242 break; 7243 } 7244 7245 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 7246 Stride = SlotSize; 7247 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, ArgPtrTy, "indirect"); 7248 ArgAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(ArgAddr, "indirect.arg"), 7249 TypeInfo.second); 7250 break; 7251 7252 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 7253 return Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeInfo.second); 7254 } 7255 7256 // Update VAList. 7257 llvm::Value *NextPtr = 7258 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), Stride, "ap.next"); 7259 Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr); 7260 7261 return Builder.CreateBitCast(ArgAddr, ArgPtrTy, "arg.addr"); 7262 } 7263 7264 void SparcV9ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7265 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyType(FI.getReturnType(), 32 * 8); 7266 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7267 I.info = classifyType(I.type, 16 * 8); 7268 } 7269 7270 namespace { 7271 class SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7272 public: 7273 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7274 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV9ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7275 7276 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 7277 return 14; 7278 } 7279 7280 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7281 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 7282 }; 7283 } // end anonymous namespace 7284 7285 bool 7286 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7287 llvm::Value *Address) const { 7288 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 7289 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 7290 7291 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7292 7293 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 7294 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 7295 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 7296 7297 // 0-31: the 8-byte general-purpose registers 7298 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 7299 7300 // 32-63: f0-31, the 4-byte floating-point registers 7301 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 32, 63); 7302 7303 // Y = 64 7304 // PSR = 65 7305 // WIM = 66 7306 // TBR = 67 7307 // PC = 68 7308 // NPC = 69 7309 // FSR = 70 7310 // CSR = 71 7311 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 71); 7312 7313 // 72-87: d0-15, the 8-byte floating-point registers 7314 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 72, 87); 7315 7316 return false; 7317 } 7318 7319 7320 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7321 // XCore ABI Implementation 7322 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7323 7324 namespace { 7325 7326 /// A SmallStringEnc instance is used to build up the TypeString by passing 7327 /// it by reference between functions that append to it. 7328 typedef llvm::SmallString<128> SmallStringEnc; 7329 7330 /// TypeStringCache caches the meta encodings of Types. 7331 /// 7332 /// The reason for caching TypeStrings is two fold: 7333 /// 1. To cache a type's encoding for later uses; 7334 /// 2. As a means to break recursive member type inclusion. 7335 /// 7336 /// A cache Entry can have a Status of: 7337 /// NonRecursive: The type encoding is not recursive; 7338 /// Recursive: The type encoding is recursive; 7339 /// Incomplete: An incomplete TypeString; 7340 /// IncompleteUsed: An incomplete TypeString that has been used in a 7341 /// Recursive type encoding. 7342 /// 7343 /// A NonRecursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully 7344 /// as possible. Whilst it may contain types which are recursive, the type 7345 /// itself is not recursive and thus its encoding may be safely used whenever 7346 /// the type is encountered. 7347 /// 7348 /// A Recursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully as 7349 /// possible. The type itself is recursive and it may contain other types which 7350 /// are recursive. The Recursive encoding must not be used during the expansion 7351 /// of a recursive type's recursive branch. For simplicity the code uses 7352 /// IncompleteCount to reject all usage of Recursive encodings for member types. 7353 /// 7354 /// An Incomplete entry is always a RecordType and only encodes its 7355 /// identifier e.g. "s(S){}". Incomplete 'StubEnc' entries are ephemeral and 7356 /// are placed into the cache during type expansion as a means to identify and 7357 /// handle recursive inclusion of types as sub-members. If there is recursion 7358 /// the entry becomes IncompleteUsed. 7359 /// 7360 /// During the expansion of a RecordType's members: 7361 /// 7362 /// If the cache contains a NonRecursive encoding for the member type, the 7363 /// cached encoding is used; 7364 /// 7365 /// If the cache contains a Recursive encoding for the member type, the 7366 /// cached encoding is 'Swapped' out, as it may be incorrect, and... 7367 /// 7368 /// If the member is a RecordType, an Incomplete encoding is placed into the 7369 /// cache to break potential recursive inclusion of itself as a sub-member; 7370 /// 7371 /// Once a member RecordType has been expanded, its temporary incomplete 7372 /// entry is removed from the cache. If a Recursive encoding was swapped out 7373 /// it is swapped back in; 7374 /// 7375 /// If an incomplete entry is used to expand a sub-member, the incomplete 7376 /// entry is marked as IncompleteUsed. The cache keeps count of how many 7377 /// IncompleteUsed entries it currently contains in IncompleteUsedCount; 7378 /// 7379 /// If a member's encoding is found to be a NonRecursive or Recursive viz: 7380 /// IncompleteUsedCount==0, the member's encoding is added to the cache. 7381 /// Else the member is part of a recursive type and thus the recursion has 7382 /// been exited too soon for the encoding to be correct for the member. 7383 /// 7384 class TypeStringCache { 7385 enum Status {NonRecursive, Recursive, Incomplete, IncompleteUsed}; 7386 struct Entry { 7387 std::string Str; // The encoded TypeString for the type. 7388 enum Status State; // Information about the encoding in 'Str'. 7389 std::string Swapped; // A temporary place holder for a Recursive encoding 7390 // during the expansion of RecordType's members. 7391 }; 7392 std::map<const IdentifierInfo *, struct Entry> Map; 7393 unsigned IncompleteCount; // Number of Incomplete entries in the Map. 7394 unsigned IncompleteUsedCount; // Number of IncompleteUsed entries in the Map. 7395 public: 7396 TypeStringCache() : IncompleteCount(0), IncompleteUsedCount(0) {} 7397 void addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, std::string StubEnc); 7398 bool removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 7399 void addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 7400 bool IsRecursive); 7401 StringRef lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 7402 }; 7403 7404 /// TypeString encodings for enum & union fields must be order. 7405 /// FieldEncoding is a helper for this ordering process. 7406 class FieldEncoding { 7407 bool HasName; 7408 std::string Enc; 7409 public: 7410 FieldEncoding(bool b, SmallStringEnc &e) : HasName(b), Enc(e.c_str()) {} 7411 StringRef str() {return Enc.c_str();} 7412 bool operator<(const FieldEncoding &rhs) const { 7413 if (HasName != rhs.HasName) return HasName; 7414 return Enc < rhs.Enc; 7415 } 7416 }; 7417 7418 class XCoreABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7419 public: 7420 XCoreABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7421 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7422 QualType Ty) const override; 7423 }; 7424 7425 class XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7426 mutable TypeStringCache TSC; 7427 public: 7428 XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7429 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new XCoreABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7430 void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7431 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7432 }; 7433 7434 } // End anonymous namespace. 7435 7436 // TODO: this implementation is likely now redundant with the default 7437 // EmitVAArg. 7438 Address XCoreABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7439 QualType Ty) const { 7440 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7441 7442 // Get the VAList. 7443 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 7444 Address AP(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 7445 7446 // Handle the argument. 7447 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 7448 CharUnits TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 7449 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 7450 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 7451 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 7452 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 7453 7454 Address Val = Address::invalid(); 7455 CharUnits ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 7456 switch (AI.getKind()) { 7457 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 7458 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 7459 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 7460 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 7461 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 7462 Val = Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeAlign); 7463 ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 7464 break; 7465 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 7466 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 7467 Val = Builder.CreateBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 7468 ArgSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 7469 getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType())); 7470 ArgSize = ArgSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 7471 break; 7472 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 7473 Val = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 7474 Val = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Val), TypeAlign); 7475 ArgSize = SlotSize; 7476 break; 7477 } 7478 7479 // Increment the VAList. 7480 if (!ArgSize.isZero()) { 7481 llvm::Value *APN = 7482 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(AP.getPointer(), ArgSize); 7483 Builder.CreateStore(APN, VAListAddr); 7484 } 7485 7486 return Val; 7487 } 7488 7489 /// During the expansion of a RecordType, an incomplete TypeString is placed 7490 /// into the cache as a means to identify and break recursion. 7491 /// If there is a Recursive encoding in the cache, it is swapped out and will 7492 /// be reinserted by removeIncomplete(). 7493 /// All other types of encoding should have been used rather than arriving here. 7494 void TypeStringCache::addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, 7495 std::string StubEnc) { 7496 if (!ID) 7497 return; 7498 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 7499 assert( (E.Str.empty() || E.State == Recursive) && 7500 "Incorrectly use of addIncomplete"); 7501 assert(!StubEnc.empty() && "Passing an empty string to addIncomplete()"); 7502 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); // swap out the Recursive 7503 E.Str.swap(StubEnc); 7504 E.State = Incomplete; 7505 ++IncompleteCount; 7506 } 7507 7508 /// Once the RecordType has been expanded, the temporary incomplete TypeString 7509 /// must be removed from the cache. 7510 /// If a Recursive was swapped out by addIncomplete(), it will be replaced. 7511 /// Returns true if the RecordType was defined recursively. 7512 bool TypeStringCache::removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 7513 if (!ID) 7514 return false; 7515 auto I = Map.find(ID); 7516 assert(I != Map.end() && "Entry not present"); 7517 Entry &E = I->second; 7518 assert( (E.State == Incomplete || 7519 E.State == IncompleteUsed) && 7520 "Entry must be an incomplete type"); 7521 bool IsRecursive = false; 7522 if (E.State == IncompleteUsed) { 7523 // We made use of our Incomplete encoding, thus we are recursive. 7524 IsRecursive = true; 7525 --IncompleteUsedCount; 7526 } 7527 if (E.Swapped.empty()) 7528 Map.erase(I); 7529 else { 7530 // Swap the Recursive back. 7531 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); 7532 E.Swapped.clear(); 7533 E.State = Recursive; 7534 } 7535 --IncompleteCount; 7536 return IsRecursive; 7537 } 7538 7539 /// Add the encoded TypeString to the cache only if it is NonRecursive or 7540 /// Recursive (viz: all sub-members were expanded as fully as possible). 7541 void TypeStringCache::addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 7542 bool IsRecursive) { 7543 if (!ID || IncompleteUsedCount) 7544 return; // No key or it is is an incomplete sub-type so don't add. 7545 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 7546 if (IsRecursive && !E.Str.empty()) { 7547 assert(E.State==Recursive && E.Str.size() == Str.size() && 7548 "This is not the same Recursive entry"); 7549 // The parent container was not recursive after all, so we could have used 7550 // this Recursive sub-member entry after all, but we assumed the worse when 7551 // we started viz: IncompleteCount!=0. 7552 return; 7553 } 7554 assert(E.Str.empty() && "Entry already present"); 7555 E.Str = Str.str(); 7556 E.State = IsRecursive? Recursive : NonRecursive; 7557 } 7558 7559 /// Return a cached TypeString encoding for the ID. If there isn't one, or we 7560 /// are recursively expanding a type (IncompleteCount != 0) and the cached 7561 /// encoding is Recursive, return an empty StringRef. 7562 StringRef TypeStringCache::lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 7563 if (!ID) 7564 return StringRef(); // We have no key. 7565 auto I = Map.find(ID); 7566 if (I == Map.end()) 7567 return StringRef(); // We have no encoding. 7568 Entry &E = I->second; 7569 if (E.State == Recursive && IncompleteCount) 7570 return StringRef(); // We don't use Recursive encodings for member types. 7571 7572 if (E.State == Incomplete) { 7573 // The incomplete type is being used to break out of recursion. 7574 E.State = IncompleteUsed; 7575 ++IncompleteUsedCount; 7576 } 7577 return E.Str.c_str(); 7578 } 7579 7580 /// The XCore ABI includes a type information section that communicates symbol 7581 /// type information to the linker. The linker uses this information to verify 7582 /// safety/correctness of things such as array bound and pointers et al. 7583 /// The ABI only requires C (and XC) language modules to emit TypeStrings. 7584 /// This type information (TypeString) is emitted into meta data for all global 7585 /// symbols: definitions, declarations, functions & variables. 7586 /// 7587 /// The TypeString carries type, qualifier, name, size & value details. 7588 /// Please see 'Tools Development Guide' section 2.16.2 for format details: 7589 /// https://www.xmos.com/download/public/Tools-Development-Guide%28X9114A%29.pdf 7590 /// The output is tested by test/CodeGen/xcore-stringtype.c. 7591 /// 7592 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 7593 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC); 7594 7595 /// XCore uses emitTargetMD to emit TypeString metadata for global symbols. 7596 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7597 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 7598 SmallStringEnc Enc; 7599 if (getTypeString(Enc, D, CGM, TSC)) { 7600 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext(); 7601 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV), 7602 llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Enc.str())}; 7603 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = 7604 CGM.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata("xcore.typestrings"); 7605 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 7606 } 7607 } 7608 7609 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7610 // SPIR ABI Implementation 7611 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7612 7613 namespace { 7614 class SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7615 public: 7616 SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7617 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7618 void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7619 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7620 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 7621 }; 7622 } // End anonymous namespace. 7623 7624 /// Emit SPIR specific metadata: OpenCL and SPIR version. 7625 void SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7626 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 7627 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext(); 7628 llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx); 7629 llvm::Module &M = CGM.getModule(); 7630 // SPIR v2.0 s2.12 - The SPIR version used by the module is stored in the 7631 // opencl.spir.version named metadata. 7632 llvm::Metadata *SPIRVerElts[] = { 7633 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::get(Int32Ty, 2)), 7634 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::get(Int32Ty, 0))}; 7635 llvm::NamedMDNode *SPIRVerMD = 7636 M.getOrInsertNamedMetadata("opencl.spir.version"); 7637 SPIRVerMD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, SPIRVerElts)); 7638 appendOpenCLVersionMD(CGM); 7639 } 7640 7641 static void appendOpenCLVersionMD (CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) { 7642 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext(); 7643 llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx); 7644 llvm::Module &M = CGM.getModule(); 7645 // SPIR v2.0 s2.13 - The OpenCL version used by the module is stored in the 7646 // opencl.ocl.version named metadata node. 7647 llvm::Metadata *OCLVerElts[] = { 7648 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::get( 7649 Int32Ty, CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion / 100)), 7650 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::get( 7651 Int32Ty, (CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion % 100) / 10))}; 7652 llvm::NamedMDNode *OCLVerMD = 7653 M.getOrInsertNamedMetadata("opencl.ocl.version"); 7654 OCLVerMD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, OCLVerElts)); 7655 } 7656 7657 unsigned SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 7658 return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL; 7659 } 7660 7661 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 7662 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7663 TypeStringCache &TSC); 7664 7665 /// Helper function for appendRecordType(). 7666 /// Builds a SmallVector containing the encoded field types in declaration 7667 /// order. 7668 static bool extractFieldType(SmallVectorImpl<FieldEncoding> &FE, 7669 const RecordDecl *RD, 7670 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7671 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 7672 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) { 7673 SmallStringEnc Enc; 7674 Enc += "m("; 7675 Enc += Field->getName(); 7676 Enc += "){"; 7677 if (Field->isBitField()) { 7678 Enc += "b("; 7679 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Enc); 7680 OS << Field->getBitWidthValue(CGM.getContext()); 7681 Enc += ':'; 7682 } 7683 if (!appendType(Enc, Field->getType(), CGM, TSC)) 7684 return false; 7685 if (Field->isBitField()) 7686 Enc += ')'; 7687 Enc += '}'; 7688 FE.emplace_back(!Field->getName().empty(), Enc); 7689 } 7690 return true; 7691 } 7692 7693 /// Appends structure and union types to Enc and adds encoding to cache. 7694 /// Recursively calls appendType (via extractFieldType) for each field. 7695 /// Union types have their fields ordered according to the ABI. 7696 static bool appendRecordType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const RecordType *RT, 7697 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7698 TypeStringCache &TSC, const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 7699 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 7700 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 7701 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 7702 Enc += TypeString; 7703 return true; 7704 } 7705 7706 // Start to emit an incomplete TypeString. 7707 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 7708 Enc += (RT->isUnionType()? 'u' : 's'); 7709 Enc += '('; 7710 if (ID) 7711 Enc += ID->getName(); 7712 Enc += "){"; 7713 7714 // We collect all encoded fields and order as necessary. 7715 bool IsRecursive = false; 7716 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl()->getDefinition(); 7717 if (RD && !RD->field_empty()) { 7718 // An incomplete TypeString stub is placed in the cache for this RecordType 7719 // so that recursive calls to this RecordType will use it whilst building a 7720 // complete TypeString for this RecordType. 7721 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 7722 std::string StubEnc(Enc.substr(Start).str()); 7723 StubEnc += '}'; // StubEnc now holds a valid incomplete TypeString. 7724 TSC.addIncomplete(ID, std::move(StubEnc)); 7725 if (!extractFieldType(FE, RD, CGM, TSC)) { 7726 (void) TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 7727 return false; 7728 } 7729 IsRecursive = TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 7730 // The ABI requires unions to be sorted but not structures. 7731 // See FieldEncoding::operator< for sort algorithm. 7732 if (RT->isUnionType()) 7733 std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end()); 7734 // We can now complete the TypeString. 7735 unsigned E = FE.size(); 7736 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 7737 if (I) 7738 Enc += ','; 7739 Enc += FE[I].str(); 7740 } 7741 } 7742 Enc += '}'; 7743 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), IsRecursive); 7744 return true; 7745 } 7746 7747 /// Appends enum types to Enc and adds the encoding to the cache. 7748 static bool appendEnumType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const EnumType *ET, 7749 TypeStringCache &TSC, 7750 const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 7751 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 7752 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 7753 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 7754 Enc += TypeString; 7755 return true; 7756 } 7757 7758 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 7759 Enc += "e("; 7760 if (ID) 7761 Enc += ID->getName(); 7762 Enc += "){"; 7763 7764 // We collect all encoded enumerations and order them alphanumerically. 7765 if (const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl()->getDefinition()) { 7766 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 7767 for (auto I = ED->enumerator_begin(), E = ED->enumerator_end(); I != E; 7768 ++I) { 7769 SmallStringEnc EnumEnc; 7770 EnumEnc += "m("; 7771 EnumEnc += I->getName(); 7772 EnumEnc += "){"; 7773 I->getInitVal().toString(EnumEnc); 7774 EnumEnc += '}'; 7775 FE.push_back(FieldEncoding(!I->getName().empty(), EnumEnc)); 7776 } 7777 std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end()); 7778 unsigned E = FE.size(); 7779 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 7780 if (I) 7781 Enc += ','; 7782 Enc += FE[I].str(); 7783 } 7784 } 7785 Enc += '}'; 7786 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), false); 7787 return true; 7788 } 7789 7790 /// Appends type's qualifier to Enc. 7791 /// This is done prior to appending the type's encoding. 7792 static void appendQualifier(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT) { 7793 // Qualifiers are emitted in alphabetical order. 7794 static const char *const Table[]={"","c:","r:","cr:","v:","cv:","rv:","crv:"}; 7795 int Lookup = 0; 7796 if (QT.isConstQualified()) 7797 Lookup += 1<<0; 7798 if (QT.isRestrictQualified()) 7799 Lookup += 1<<1; 7800 if (QT.isVolatileQualified()) 7801 Lookup += 1<<2; 7802 Enc += Table[Lookup]; 7803 } 7804 7805 /// Appends built-in types to Enc. 7806 static bool appendBuiltinType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const BuiltinType *BT) { 7807 const char *EncType; 7808 switch (BT->getKind()) { 7809 case BuiltinType::Void: 7810 EncType = "0"; 7811 break; 7812 case BuiltinType::Bool: 7813 EncType = "b"; 7814 break; 7815 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 7816 EncType = "uc"; 7817 break; 7818 case BuiltinType::UChar: 7819 EncType = "uc"; 7820 break; 7821 case BuiltinType::SChar: 7822 EncType = "sc"; 7823 break; 7824 case BuiltinType::UShort: 7825 EncType = "us"; 7826 break; 7827 case BuiltinType::Short: 7828 EncType = "ss"; 7829 break; 7830 case BuiltinType::UInt: 7831 EncType = "ui"; 7832 break; 7833 case BuiltinType::Int: 7834 EncType = "si"; 7835 break; 7836 case BuiltinType::ULong: 7837 EncType = "ul"; 7838 break; 7839 case BuiltinType::Long: 7840 EncType = "sl"; 7841 break; 7842 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 7843 EncType = "ull"; 7844 break; 7845 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 7846 EncType = "sll"; 7847 break; 7848 case BuiltinType::Float: 7849 EncType = "ft"; 7850 break; 7851 case BuiltinType::Double: 7852 EncType = "d"; 7853 break; 7854 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 7855 EncType = "ld"; 7856 break; 7857 default: 7858 return false; 7859 } 7860 Enc += EncType; 7861 return true; 7862 } 7863 7864 /// Appends a pointer encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the pointee. 7865 static bool appendPointerType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const PointerType *PT, 7866 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7867 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 7868 Enc += "p("; 7869 if (!appendType(Enc, PT->getPointeeType(), CGM, TSC)) 7870 return false; 7871 Enc += ')'; 7872 return true; 7873 } 7874 7875 /// Appends array encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the element. 7876 static bool appendArrayType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT, 7877 const ArrayType *AT, 7878 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7879 TypeStringCache &TSC, StringRef NoSizeEnc) { 7880 if (AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Normal) 7881 return false; 7882 Enc += "a("; 7883 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 7884 CAT->getSize().toStringUnsigned(Enc); 7885 else 7886 Enc += NoSizeEnc; // Global arrays use "*", otherwise it is "". 7887 Enc += ':'; 7888 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 7889 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 7890 if (!appendType(Enc, AT->getElementType(), CGM, TSC)) 7891 return false; 7892 Enc += ')'; 7893 return true; 7894 } 7895 7896 /// Appends a function encoding to Enc, calling appendType for the return type 7897 /// and the arguments. 7898 static bool appendFunctionType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const FunctionType *FT, 7899 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7900 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 7901 Enc += "f{"; 7902 if (!appendType(Enc, FT->getReturnType(), CGM, TSC)) 7903 return false; 7904 Enc += "}("; 7905 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 7906 // N.B. we are only interested in the adjusted param types. 7907 auto I = FPT->param_type_begin(); 7908 auto E = FPT->param_type_end(); 7909 if (I != E) { 7910 do { 7911 if (!appendType(Enc, *I, CGM, TSC)) 7912 return false; 7913 ++I; 7914 if (I != E) 7915 Enc += ','; 7916 } while (I != E); 7917 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 7918 Enc += ",va"; 7919 } else { 7920 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 7921 Enc += "va"; 7922 else 7923 Enc += '0'; 7924 } 7925 } 7926 Enc += ')'; 7927 return true; 7928 } 7929 7930 /// Handles the type's qualifier before dispatching a call to handle specific 7931 /// type encodings. 7932 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 7933 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7934 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 7935 7936 QualType QT = QType.getCanonicalType(); 7937 7938 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) 7939 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 7940 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 7941 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, ""); 7942 7943 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 7944 7945 if (const BuiltinType *BT = QT->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 7946 return appendBuiltinType(Enc, BT); 7947 7948 if (const PointerType *PT = QT->getAs<PointerType>()) 7949 return appendPointerType(Enc, PT, CGM, TSC); 7950 7951 if (const EnumType *ET = QT->getAs<EnumType>()) 7952 return appendEnumType(Enc, ET, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 7953 7954 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsStructureType()) 7955 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 7956 7957 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsUnionType()) 7958 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 7959 7960 if (const FunctionType *FT = QT->getAs<FunctionType>()) 7961 return appendFunctionType(Enc, FT, CGM, TSC); 7962 7963 return false; 7964 } 7965 7966 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 7967 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC) { 7968 if (!D) 7969 return false; 7970 7971 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 7972 if (FD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 7973 return false; 7974 return appendType(Enc, FD->getType(), CGM, TSC); 7975 } 7976 7977 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 7978 if (VD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 7979 return false; 7980 QualType QT = VD->getType().getCanonicalType(); 7981 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) { 7982 // Global ArrayTypes are given a size of '*' if the size is unknown. 7983 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 7984 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 7985 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "*"); 7986 } 7987 return appendType(Enc, QT, CGM, TSC); 7988 } 7989 return false; 7990 } 7991 7992 7993 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7994 // Driver code 7995 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7996 7997 const llvm::Triple &CodeGenModule::getTriple() const { 7998 return getTarget().getTriple(); 7999 } 8000 8001 bool CodeGenModule::supportsCOMDAT() const { 8002 return getTriple().supportsCOMDAT(); 8003 } 8004 8005 const TargetCodeGenInfo &CodeGenModule::getTargetCodeGenInfo() { 8006 if (TheTargetCodeGenInfo) 8007 return *TheTargetCodeGenInfo; 8008 8009 // Helper to set the unique_ptr while still keeping the return value. 8010 auto SetCGInfo = [&](TargetCodeGenInfo *P) -> const TargetCodeGenInfo & { 8011 this->TheTargetCodeGenInfo.reset(P); 8012 return *P; 8013 }; 8014 8015 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 8016 switch (Triple.getArch()) { 8017 default: 8018 return SetCGInfo(new DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8019 8020 case llvm::Triple::le32: 8021 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8022 case llvm::Triple::mips: 8023 case llvm::Triple::mipsel: 8024 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::NaCl) 8025 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8026 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, true)); 8027 8028 case llvm::Triple::mips64: 8029 case llvm::Triple::mips64el: 8030 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, false)); 8031 8032 case llvm::Triple::aarch64: 8033 case llvm::Triple::aarch64_be: { 8034 AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS; 8035 if (getTarget().getABI() == "darwinpcs") 8036 Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::DarwinPCS; 8037 8038 return SetCGInfo(new AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 8039 } 8040 8041 case llvm::Triple::wasm32: 8042 case llvm::Triple::wasm64: 8043 return SetCGInfo(new WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8044 8045 case llvm::Triple::arm: 8046 case llvm::Triple::armeb: 8047 case llvm::Triple::thumb: 8048 case llvm::Triple::thumbeb: { 8049 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 8050 return SetCGInfo( 8051 new WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP)); 8052 } 8053 8054 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS; 8055 StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI(); 8056 if (ABIStr == "apcs-gnu") 8057 Kind = ARMABIInfo::APCS; 8058 else if (ABIStr == "aapcs16") 8059 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP; 8060 else if (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "hard" || 8061 (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI != "soft" && 8062 (Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF || 8063 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF || 8064 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::EABIHF))) 8065 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP; 8066 8067 return SetCGInfo(new ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 8068 } 8069 8070 case llvm::Triple::ppc: 8071 return SetCGInfo( 8072 new PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 8073 case llvm::Triple::ppc64: 8074 if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF()) { 8075 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 8076 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv2") 8077 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 8078 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 8079 8080 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX)); 8081 } else 8082 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8083 case llvm::Triple::ppc64le: { 8084 assert(Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && "PPC64 LE non-ELF not supported!"); 8085 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 8086 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1" || getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx") 8087 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 8088 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 8089 8090 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX)); 8091 } 8092 8093 case llvm::Triple::nvptx: 8094 case llvm::Triple::nvptx64: 8095 return SetCGInfo(new NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8096 8097 case llvm::Triple::msp430: 8098 return SetCGInfo(new MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8099 8100 case llvm::Triple::systemz: { 8101 bool HasVector = getTarget().getABI() == "vector"; 8102 return SetCGInfo(new SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, HasVector)); 8103 } 8104 8105 case llvm::Triple::tce: 8106 return SetCGInfo(new TCETargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8107 8108 case llvm::Triple::x86: { 8109 bool IsDarwinVectorABI = Triple.isOSDarwin(); 8110 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI = 8111 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts); 8112 bool IsWin32FloatStructABI = Triple.isOSWindows() && !Triple.isOSCygMing(); 8113 8114 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 8115 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 8116 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 8117 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters)); 8118 } else { 8119 return SetCGInfo(new X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 8120 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 8121 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters, 8122 CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 8123 } 8124 } 8125 8126 case llvm::Triple::x86_64: { 8127 StringRef ABI = getTarget().getABI(); 8128 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel = 8129 (ABI == "avx512" 8130 ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX512 8131 : ABI == "avx" ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX : X86AVXABILevel::None); 8132 8133 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 8134 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 8135 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8136 case llvm::Triple::PS4: 8137 return SetCGInfo(new PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8138 default: 8139 return SetCGInfo(new X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8140 } 8141 } 8142 case llvm::Triple::hexagon: 8143 return SetCGInfo(new HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8144 case llvm::Triple::lanai: 8145 return SetCGInfo(new LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8146 case llvm::Triple::r600: 8147 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8148 case llvm::Triple::amdgcn: 8149 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8150 case llvm::Triple::sparc: 8151 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8152 case llvm::Triple::sparcv9: 8153 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8154 case llvm::Triple::xcore: 8155 return SetCGInfo(new XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8156 case llvm::Triple::spir: 8157 case llvm::Triple::spir64: 8158 return SetCGInfo(new SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8159 } 8160 } 8161